2010-07-07 Sergio Durigan Junior <sergiodj@linux.vnet.ibm.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64 #include "parser-defs.h"
65
66 /* readline include files */
67 #include "readline/readline.h"
68 #include "readline/history.h"
69
70 /* readline defines this. */
71 #undef savestring
72
73 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
74
75 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
76 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
77 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
78
79 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
80
81 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
82
83 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
84
85 static void disable_command (char *, int);
86
87 static void enable_command (char *, int);
88
89 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
90 void *),
91 void *);
92
93 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
94
95 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
96
97 static void clear_command (char *, int);
98
99 static void catch_command (char *, int);
100
101 static void watch_command (char *, int);
102
103 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
104
105 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
106
107 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
108
109 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
110 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
111 struct symtab_and_line,
112 enum bptype);
113
114 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
115
116 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
117 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
118 enum bptype bptype);
119
120 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
121 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
122 struct obj_section *, int);
123
124 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
125 CORE_ADDR addr1,
126 struct address_space *aspace2,
127 CORE_ADDR addr2);
128
129 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
130 struct bp_location *loc2);
131
132 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
133
134 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
135
136 static int breakpoint_1 (int, int, int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
137
138 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
139
140 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
141
142 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
143
144 static void commands_command (char *, int);
145
146 static void condition_command (char *, int);
147
148 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
149
150 typedef enum
151 {
152 mark_inserted,
153 mark_uninserted
154 }
155 insertion_state_t;
156
157 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
158 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
159
160 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
161
162 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
163
164 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
165
166 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
167
168 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
169
170 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
171
172 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
175
176 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
177
178 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
179
180 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
181
182 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
183
184 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
186 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
189
190 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
191
192 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
193 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
194
195 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
196
197 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
198
199 static void detach_single_step_breakpoints (void);
200
201 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
202 CORE_ADDR pc);
203
204 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
205
206 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
207
208 static void update_global_location_list (int);
209
210 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
211
212 static int bpstat_remove_bp_location_callback (struct thread_info *th,
213 void *data);
214
215 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
216
217 static int is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
218
219 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
220
221 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
222
223 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
224
225 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
226
227 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
228
229 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
230
231 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
232
233 /* Assuming we're creating a static tracepoint, does S look like a
234 static tracepoint marker spec ("-m MARKER_ID")? */
235 #define is_marker_spec(s) \
236 (strncmp (s, "-m", 2) == 0 && ((s)[2] == ' ' || (s)[2] == '\t'))
237
238 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
239 breakpoints share a single command list. */
240 struct counted_command_line
241 {
242 /* The reference count. */
243 int refc;
244
245 /* The command list. */
246 struct command_line *commands;
247 };
248
249 struct command_line *
250 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
251 {
252 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
253 }
254
255 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
256 current breakpoint. */
257
258 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
259
260 static const char *
261 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
262 {
263 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
264 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
265 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
266
267 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
268 }
269
270 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
271 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
272 if such is available. */
273 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
274
275 static void
276 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
277 struct cmd_list_element *c,
278 const char *value)
279 {
280 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
281 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
282 value);
283 }
284
285 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
286 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
287 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
288 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
289 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
290 static void
291 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
292 struct cmd_list_element *c,
293 const char *value)
294 {
295 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
296 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
297 value);
298 }
299
300 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
301 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
302 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
303 use hardware breakpoints. */
304 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
305 static void
306 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
307 struct cmd_list_element *c,
308 const char *value)
309 {
310 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
311 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
312 value);
313 }
314
315 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
316 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
317 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
318 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
319 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
320
321 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
322 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
323 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
324 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
325 always_inserted_auto,
326 always_inserted_off,
327 always_inserted_on,
328 NULL
329 };
330 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
331 static void
332 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
333 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
334 {
335 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
336 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
337 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
338 value,
339 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
340 else
341 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
342 }
343
344 int
345 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
346 {
347 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
348 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
349 }
350
351 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
352
353 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
354 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
355
356 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
357 static int overlay_events_enabled;
358
359 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
360 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
361 breakpoint. */
362
363 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
364
365 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
366 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
367 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
368 B = TMP)
369
370 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
371 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
372 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
373
374 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
375 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
376 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
377 BP_TMP++)
378
379 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
380
381 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
382 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
383 if (is_tracepoint (B))
384
385 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
386
387 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
388
389 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
390
391 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
392
393 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
394
395 static unsigned bp_location_count;
396
397 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
398 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
399 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
400 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
401
402 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
403
404 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
405 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
406 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
407 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
408 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
409
410 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
411
412 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
413 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
414 may still be reported by a target. */
415 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
416
417 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
418
419 static int breakpoint_count;
420
421 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
422 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
423 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
424 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
425 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
426
427 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
428
429 static int tracepoint_count;
430
431 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
432 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
433 static struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
434
435 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
436 static int
437 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
438 {
439 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
440 }
441
442 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
443
444 static void
445 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
446 {
447 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
448 breakpoint_count = num;
449 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
450 }
451
452 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
453 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
454 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
455
456 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
457 breakpoint made. */
458
459 void
460 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
461 {
462 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
463 }
464
465 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
466 breakpoint made. */
467
468 void
469 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
470 {
471 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
472 }
473
474 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
475
476 void
477 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
478 {
479 struct breakpoint *b;
480
481 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
482 b->hit_count = 0;
483 }
484
485 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
486 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
487
488 static struct counted_command_line *
489 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
490 {
491 struct counted_command_line *result
492 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct counted_command_line));
493
494 result->refc = 1;
495 result->commands = commands;
496 return result;
497 }
498
499 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
500
501 static void
502 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
503 {
504 if (cmd)
505 ++cmd->refc;
506 }
507
508 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
509 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
510 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
511
512 static void
513 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
514 {
515 if (*cmdp)
516 {
517 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
518 {
519 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
520 xfree (*cmdp);
521 }
522 *cmdp = NULL;
523 }
524 }
525
526 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
527
528 static void
529 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
530 {
531 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
532 }
533
534 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
535 argument. */
536
537 static struct cleanup *
538 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
539 {
540 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
541 }
542
543 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
544 for "break" command with no arg.
545 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
546 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
547
548 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
549
550 int default_breakpoint_valid;
551 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
552 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
553 int default_breakpoint_line;
554 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
555
556 \f
557 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
558 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
559
560 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
561 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
562 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
563
564 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
565
566 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
567 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
568 static int
569 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
570 {
571 int retval = 0; /* default */
572 char *p = *pp;
573
574 if (p == NULL)
575 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
576 return breakpoint_count;
577 else if (*p == '$')
578 {
579 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
580 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
581 char *varname;
582 char *start = ++p;
583 LONGEST val;
584
585 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
586 p++;
587 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
588 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
589 varname[p - start] = '\0';
590 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
591 retval = (int) val;
592 else
593 {
594 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
595 retval = 0;
596 }
597 }
598 else
599 {
600 if (*p == '-')
601 ++p;
602 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
603 ++p;
604 if (p == *pp)
605 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
606 {
607 /* Skip non-numeric token */
608 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
609 ++p;
610 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
611 retval = 0;
612 }
613 else
614 retval = atoi (*pp);
615 }
616 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
617 {
618 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
619 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
620 ++p;
621 retval = 0;
622 }
623 while (isspace (*p))
624 p++;
625 *pp = p;
626 return retval;
627 }
628
629
630 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
631 int
632 get_number (char **pp)
633 {
634 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
635 }
636
637 /* Parse a number or a range.
638 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
639 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
640 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
641 * inclusive.
642 *
643 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
644 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
645 *
646 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
647 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
648 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
649 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
650 * pointer PP past <number2>.
651 */
652
653 int
654 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
655 {
656 static int last_retval, end_value;
657 static char *end_ptr;
658 static int in_range = 0;
659
660 if (**pp != '-')
661 {
662 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
663 or to the first number of a range. */
664 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
665 if (**pp == '-')
666 {
667 char **temp;
668
669 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
670 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
671 and also remember the end of the final token. */
672
673 temp = &end_ptr;
674 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
675 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
676 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
677 end_value = get_number (temp);
678 if (end_value < last_retval)
679 {
680 error (_("inverted range"));
681 }
682 else if (end_value == last_retval)
683 {
684 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
685 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
686 single number. */
687 *pp = end_ptr;
688 }
689 else
690 in_range = 1;
691 }
692 }
693 else if (! in_range)
694 error (_("negative value"));
695 else
696 {
697 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
698 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
699 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
700 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
701 is reached. */
702
703 if (++last_retval == end_value)
704 {
705 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
706 *pp = end_ptr;
707 in_range = 0;
708 }
709 }
710 return last_retval;
711 }
712
713 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
714 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
715
716 struct breakpoint *
717 get_breakpoint (int num)
718 {
719 struct breakpoint *b;
720
721 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
722 if (b->number == num)
723 return b;
724
725 return NULL;
726 }
727
728 \f
729
730 void
731 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, char *exp,
732 int from_tty)
733 {
734 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
735
736 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
737 {
738 xfree (loc->cond);
739 loc->cond = NULL;
740 }
741 xfree (b->cond_string);
742 b->cond_string = NULL;
743 xfree (b->cond_exp);
744 b->cond_exp = NULL;
745
746 if (*exp == 0)
747 {
748 if (from_tty)
749 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
750 }
751 else
752 {
753 char *arg = exp;
754
755 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
756 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
757 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
758 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
759
760 if (is_watchpoint (b))
761 {
762 innermost_block = NULL;
763 arg = exp;
764 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
765 if (*arg)
766 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
767 b->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
768 }
769 else
770 {
771 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
772 {
773 arg = exp;
774 loc->cond =
775 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
776 if (*arg)
777 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
778 }
779 }
780 }
781 breakpoints_changed ();
782 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
783 }
784
785 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
786
787 static void
788 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
789 {
790 struct breakpoint *b;
791 char *p;
792 int bnum;
793
794 if (arg == 0)
795 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
796
797 p = arg;
798 bnum = get_number (&p);
799 if (bnum == 0)
800 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
801
802 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
803 if (b->number == bnum)
804 {
805 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
806 return;
807 }
808
809 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
810 }
811
812 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
813 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
814 Throw if any such commands is found.
815 */
816 static void
817 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
818 {
819 struct command_line *c;
820
821 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
822 {
823 int i;
824
825 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
826 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
827
828 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
829 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
830
831 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
832 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
833 command directly. */
834 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
835 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
836
837 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
838 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
839 }
840 }
841
842 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
843
844 int
845 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
846 {
847 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint
848 || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
849 || b->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
850 }
851
852 /* A helper function that validsates that COMMANDS are valid for a
853 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
854 found. */
855
856 static void
857 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
858 struct command_line *commands)
859 {
860 if (is_tracepoint (b))
861 {
862 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands
863 is valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one while-stepping
864 element, and that while-stepping's body has valid tracing commands
865 excluding nested while-stepping. */
866 struct command_line *c;
867 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
868 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
869 {
870 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
871 {
872 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
873 error (_("\
874 The 'while-stepping' command cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
875 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
876 error (_("\
877 The 'while-stepping' command cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
878
879 if (while_stepping)
880 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can be used only once"));
881 else
882 while_stepping = c;
883 }
884 }
885 if (while_stepping)
886 {
887 struct command_line *c2;
888
889 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
890 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
891 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
892 {
893 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
894 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
895 }
896 }
897 }
898 else
899 {
900 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
901 }
902 }
903
904 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
905 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
906
907 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
908 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
909 {
910 struct breakpoint *b;
911 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
912 struct bp_location *loc;
913
914 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
915 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
916 {
917 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
918 if (loc->address == addr)
919 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
920 }
921
922 return found;
923 }
924
925 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
926 validate that only allowed commands are included.
927 */
928
929 void
930 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
931 {
932 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
933
934 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
935 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
936 breakpoints_changed ();
937 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
938 }
939
940 void
941 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
942 {
943 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
944
945 validate_actionline (&line, b);
946 }
947
948 /* A structure used to pass information through
949 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
950
951 struct commands_info
952 {
953 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
954 int from_tty;
955
956 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
957 char *arg;
958
959 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
960 already-parsed command. */
961 struct command_line *control;
962
963 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
964 yet been read. */
965 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
966 };
967
968 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
969 commands_command. */
970
971 static void
972 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
973 {
974 struct commands_info *info = data;
975
976 if (info->cmd == NULL)
977 {
978 struct command_line *l;
979
980 if (info->control != NULL)
981 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
982 else
983 {
984 struct cleanup *old_chain;
985 char *str;
986
987 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) %s, one per line."),
988 info->arg);
989
990 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
991
992 l = read_command_lines (str,
993 info->from_tty, 1,
994 (is_tracepoint (b)
995 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
996 b);
997
998 do_cleanups (old_chain);
999 }
1000
1001 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1002 }
1003
1004 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1005 do anything. */
1006 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1007 {
1008 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1009 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1010 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1011 b->commands = info->cmd;
1012 breakpoints_changed ();
1013 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
1014 }
1015 }
1016
1017 static void
1018 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct command_line *control)
1019 {
1020 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1021 struct commands_info info;
1022
1023 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1024 info.control = control;
1025 info.cmd = NULL;
1026 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1027 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1028 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1029
1030 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1031 {
1032 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1033 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1, breakpoint_count);
1034 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1035 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1036 else
1037 {
1038 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1039 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1040 numbers will fail in this case. */
1041 arg = NULL;
1042 }
1043 }
1044 else
1045 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1046 our argument. */
1047 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1048
1049 if (arg != NULL)
1050 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1051
1052 info.arg = arg;
1053
1054 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1055
1056 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1057 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1058
1059 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1060 }
1061
1062 static void
1063 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1064 {
1065 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1066 }
1067
1068 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1069 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1070
1071 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1072 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1073 enum command_control_type
1074 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1075 {
1076 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1077 return simple_control;
1078 }
1079
1080 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1081
1082 static int
1083 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1084 {
1085 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1086 return 0;
1087 if (!bl->inserted)
1088 return 0;
1089 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1090 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1091 return 0;
1092 return 1;
1093 }
1094
1095 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1096 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1097
1098 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1099 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1100 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1101 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1102 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1103 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1104 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1105 and:
1106 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1107
1108 void
1109 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1110 {
1111 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
1112 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1113
1114 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
1115 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
1116
1117 bc_l = 0;
1118 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1119 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1120 {
1121 struct bp_location *b;
1122
1123 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1124 b = bp_location[bc];
1125
1126 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
1127 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
1128 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1129
1130 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
1131 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
1132 MEMADDR. */
1133
1134 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
1135 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
1136 bc_l = bc;
1137 else
1138 bc_r = bc;
1139 }
1140
1141 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1142
1143 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1144 {
1145 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
1146 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1147 int bp_size = 0;
1148 int bptoffset = 0;
1149
1150 /* bp_location array has B->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1151 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
1152 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1153 b->owner->number);
1154
1155 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
1156 content. */
1157
1158 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1159 && memaddr + len <= b->address
1160 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1161 break;
1162
1163 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
1164 continue;
1165 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
1166 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1167 continue;
1168
1169 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1170 we need to copy. */
1171 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
1172 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
1173
1174 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1175 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
1176 are reading. */
1177 continue;
1178
1179 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1180 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1181 reading. */
1182 continue;
1183
1184 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1185 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1186 {
1187 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1188 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1189 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1190 bp_addr = memaddr;
1191 }
1192
1193 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1194 {
1195 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1196 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1197 }
1198
1199 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1200 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1201 }
1202 }
1203 \f
1204
1205 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
1206 static void
1207 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
1208 {
1209 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
1210
1211 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
1212 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
1213
1214 b->ops->insert (b);
1215 }
1216
1217 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1218
1219 static int
1220 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1221 {
1222 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1223 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1224 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1225 }
1226
1227 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1228 software. */
1229
1230 static int
1231 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1232 {
1233 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1234 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1235 }
1236
1237 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
1238 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
1239 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1240 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1241 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1242 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1243 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1244 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1245 running. */
1246
1247 static int
1248 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1249 {
1250 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1251 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1252 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1253 }
1254
1255 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1256 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1257 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1258 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1259 in b->loc->cond.
1260 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1261
1262 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1263 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1264
1265 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1266 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1267 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1268 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1269 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1270 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1271 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1272
1273 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1274 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1275 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1276 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1277 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1278 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1279 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1280 memory content has not changed.
1281
1282 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1283 watchpoints:
1284
1285 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1286 several times when GDB stops.
1287
1288 [linux]
1289 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1290 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1291 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1292 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1293 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1294 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1295 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1296 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1297 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1298 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1299
1300 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1301 removal from inferior. */
1302
1303 static void
1304 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1305 {
1306 int within_current_scope;
1307 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1308 int frame_saved;
1309
1310 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1311 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1312 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1313 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1314 return;
1315
1316 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1317 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1318 breakpoints if needed. */
1319 b->loc = NULL;
1320
1321 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1322 return;
1323
1324 frame_saved = 0;
1325
1326 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1327 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1328 within_current_scope = 1;
1329 else
1330 {
1331 struct frame_info *fi;
1332
1333 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1334 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1335 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1336 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1337 selected frame. */
1338 frame_saved = 1;
1339 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1340
1341 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1342 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1343 if (within_current_scope)
1344 select_frame (fi);
1345 }
1346
1347 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1348 {
1349 char *s;
1350 if (b->exp)
1351 {
1352 xfree (b->exp);
1353 b->exp = NULL;
1354 }
1355 s = b->exp_string;
1356 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1357 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1358 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1359 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1360 be completely different objects. */
1361 value_free (b->val);
1362 b->val = NULL;
1363 b->val_valid = 0;
1364
1365 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1366 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1367 locations (re)created below. */
1368 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1369 {
1370 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1371 {
1372 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1373 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1374 }
1375
1376 s = b->cond_string;
1377 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1378 }
1379 }
1380
1381 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1382 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1383 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1384 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1385 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1386 if ( !target_has_execution)
1387 {
1388 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1389 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1390 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1391 }
1392 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1393 {
1394 int pc = 0;
1395 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1396 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1397
1398 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1399
1400 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1401 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1402 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1403 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1404 if (!b->val_valid)
1405 {
1406 b->val = v;
1407 b->val_valid = 1;
1408 }
1409
1410 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1411 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1412 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1413 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1414 && reparse)
1415 {
1416 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1417
1418 /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1419 for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1420 enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1421 To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1422 this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1423 watchpoint. */
1424 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1425 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1426 &other_type_used);
1427 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1428
1429 if (!mem_cnt)
1430 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1431 else
1432 {
1433 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1434 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1435 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1436 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1437 else
1438 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1439 }
1440 }
1441
1442 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1443
1444 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1445 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1446 {
1447 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1448 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1449 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1450 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1451 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1452 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1453 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1454 {
1455 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1456
1457 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1458 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1459 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1460 if (v == result
1461 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1462 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1463 {
1464 CORE_ADDR addr;
1465 int len, type;
1466 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1467
1468 addr = value_address (v);
1469 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1470 type = hw_write;
1471 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1472 type = hw_read;
1473 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1474 type = hw_access;
1475
1476 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1477 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1478 ;
1479 *tmp = loc;
1480 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1481
1482 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1483 loc->address = addr;
1484 loc->length = len;
1485 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1486 }
1487 }
1488
1489 next = value_next (v);
1490 if (v != b->val)
1491 value_free (v);
1492 }
1493
1494 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1495 above left it without any location set up. But,
1496 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1497 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1498 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1499 {
1500 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1501 b->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1502 b->loc->address = -1;
1503 b->loc->length = -1;
1504 b->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1505 }
1506 }
1507 else if (!within_current_scope)
1508 {
1509 printf_filtered (_("\
1510 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1511 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1512 b->number);
1513 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1514 {
1515 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1516 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
1517 b->related_breakpoint= NULL;
1518 }
1519 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1520 }
1521
1522 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1523 if (frame_saved)
1524 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1525 }
1526
1527
1528 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1529 inserted in the inferior. */
1530 static int
1531 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1532 {
1533 if (bpt->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1534 return 0;
1535
1536 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1537 return 0;
1538
1539 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1540 return 0;
1541
1542 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1543 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1544 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1545 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1546 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1547 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1548 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1549 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1550 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1551 return 0;
1552
1553 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1554 not by us. */
1555 if (is_tracepoint (bpt->owner))
1556 return 0;
1557
1558 return 1;
1559 }
1560
1561 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1562 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1563 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1564
1565 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1566 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1567 static int
1568 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1569 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1570 int *disabled_breaks,
1571 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1572 {
1573 int val = 0;
1574
1575 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1576 return 0;
1577
1578 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1579 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1580 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1581 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1582
1583 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1584 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1585 {
1586 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1587 {
1588 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1589 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1590 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1591 Two important cases are:
1592 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1593 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1594 hardware breakpoint.
1595 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1596 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1597 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1598
1599 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1600 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1601 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1602 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1603 struct mem_region *mr
1604 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1605
1606 if (mr)
1607 {
1608 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1609 {
1610 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1611
1612 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1613 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1614 else
1615 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1616
1617 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1618 {
1619 static int said = 0;
1620
1621 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1622 if (!said)
1623 {
1624 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1625 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1626 said = 1;
1627 }
1628 }
1629 }
1630 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1631 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1632 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1633 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1634 }
1635 }
1636
1637 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1638 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1639 || bpt->section == NULL
1640 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1641 {
1642 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1643
1644 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1645 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1646 &bpt->target_info);
1647 else
1648 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1649 &bpt->target_info);
1650 }
1651 else
1652 {
1653 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1654 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1655 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1656 {
1657 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1658 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1659 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1660 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1661 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1662 bpt->owner->number);
1663 else
1664 {
1665 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1666 bpt->section);
1667 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1668 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1669 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1670 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1671 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1672 if (val != 0)
1673 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1674 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1675 bpt->owner->number);
1676 }
1677 }
1678 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1679 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1680 {
1681 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1682 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1683 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1684 &bpt->target_info);
1685 else
1686 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1687 &bpt->target_info);
1688 }
1689 else
1690 {
1691 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1692 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1693 return 0;
1694 }
1695 }
1696
1697 if (val)
1698 {
1699 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1700 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1701 {
1702 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1703 val = 0;
1704 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1705 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1706 {
1707 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1708 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1709 bpt->owner->number);
1710 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1711 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1712 }
1713 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1714 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1715 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1716 }
1717 else
1718 {
1719 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1720 {
1721 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1722 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1723 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1724 bpt->owner->number);
1725 }
1726 else
1727 {
1728 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1729 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1730 bpt->owner->number);
1731 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1732 "Error accessing memory address ");
1733 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1734 tmp_error_stream);
1735 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1736 safe_strerror (val));
1737 }
1738
1739 }
1740 }
1741 else
1742 bpt->inserted = 1;
1743
1744 return val;
1745 }
1746
1747 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1748 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1749 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1750 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1751 {
1752 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1753 bpt->length,
1754 bpt->watchpoint_type,
1755 bpt->owner->cond_exp);
1756
1757 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1758 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1759 if (val == 1 && bpt->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1760 {
1761 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1762
1763 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1764 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1765 of this one. */
1766 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1767 if (loc != bpt
1768 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1769 && watchpoint_locations_match (bpt, loc))
1770 {
1771 bpt->duplicate = 1;
1772 bpt->inserted = 1;
1773 bpt->target_info = loc->target_info;
1774 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1775 val = 0;
1776 break;
1777 }
1778
1779 if (val == 1)
1780 {
1781 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1782 bpt->length,
1783 hw_access,
1784 bpt->owner->cond_exp);
1785 if (val == 0)
1786 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1787 }
1788 }
1789
1790 bpt->inserted = (val == 0);
1791 }
1792
1793 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1794 {
1795 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1796 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1797 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1798 bpt->owner->number);
1799 if (e.reason < 0)
1800 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1801 else
1802 bpt->inserted = 1;
1803
1804 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1805 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1806 so just return success. */
1807 return 0;
1808 }
1809
1810 return 0;
1811 }
1812
1813 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1814 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1815 PSPACE anymore. */
1816
1817 void
1818 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1819 {
1820 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1821 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1822
1823 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1824 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1825 {
1826 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1827 delete_breakpoint (b);
1828 }
1829
1830 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1831 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1832 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1833 {
1834 struct bp_location *tmp;
1835
1836 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1837 {
1838 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1839 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1840 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1841 else
1842 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1843 if (tmp->next == loc)
1844 {
1845 tmp->next = loc->next;
1846 break;
1847 }
1848 }
1849 }
1850
1851 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1852 removed locations above. */
1853 update_global_location_list (0);
1854 }
1855
1856 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1857 Throws exception on any error.
1858 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1859 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1860 void
1861 insert_breakpoints (void)
1862 {
1863 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1864
1865 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1866 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1867 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1868
1869 update_global_location_list (1);
1870
1871 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1872 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1873 now. */
1874 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1875 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1876 }
1877
1878 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1879 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1880 Both return zero if successful,
1881 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1882
1883 static void
1884 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1885 {
1886 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1887 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1888 int error = 0;
1889 int val = 0;
1890 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1891 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1892
1893 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1894 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1895
1896 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1897 there was an error. */
1898 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1899
1900 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1901
1902 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1903 {
1904 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1905 continue;
1906
1907 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1908 thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has B->OWNER
1909 always non-NULL. */
1910 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1911 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1912 continue;
1913
1914 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1915
1916 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1917 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1918 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1919 insert breakpoints. */
1920 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1921 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1922 continue;
1923
1924 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1925 &disabled_breaks,
1926 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1927 if (val)
1928 error = val;
1929 }
1930
1931 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1932 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1933 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1934 {
1935 int some_failed = 0;
1936 struct bp_location *loc;
1937
1938 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1939 continue;
1940
1941 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1942 continue;
1943
1944 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1945 continue;
1946
1947 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1948 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1949 {
1950 some_failed = 1;
1951 break;
1952 }
1953 if (some_failed)
1954 {
1955 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1956 if (loc->inserted)
1957 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1958
1959 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1960 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1961 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1962 bpt->number);
1963 error = -1;
1964 }
1965 }
1966
1967 if (error)
1968 {
1969 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1970 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1971 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1972 {
1973 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1974 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1975 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1976 }
1977 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1978 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1979 }
1980
1981 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1982 }
1983
1984 int
1985 remove_breakpoints (void)
1986 {
1987 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1988 int val = 0;
1989
1990 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1991 {
1992 if (b->inserted)
1993 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1994 }
1995 return val;
1996 }
1997
1998 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1999
2000 int
2001 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
2002 {
2003 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
2004 int val;
2005 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2006
2007 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
2008 {
2009 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2010 continue;
2011
2012 if (b->inserted)
2013 {
2014 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
2015 if (val != 0)
2016 return val;
2017 }
2018 }
2019 return 0;
2020 }
2021
2022 int
2023 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
2024 {
2025 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2026 int val = 0;
2027
2028 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2029 {
2030 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2031 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
2032 }
2033 return val;
2034 }
2035
2036 int
2037 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
2038 {
2039 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2040 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2041 int val;
2042 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2043 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
2044 struct inferior *inf;
2045 struct thread_info *tp;
2046
2047 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
2048 if (tp == NULL)
2049 return 1;
2050
2051 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2052 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2053
2054 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
2055
2056 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2057
2058 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2059 {
2060 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2061 continue;
2062
2063 if (b->inserted)
2064 {
2065 b->inserted = 0;
2066 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
2067 &dummy1, &dummy2);
2068 if (val != 0)
2069 {
2070 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2071 return val;
2072 }
2073 }
2074 }
2075 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2076 return 0;
2077 }
2078
2079 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
2080
2081 static struct breakpoint *
2082 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
2083 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
2084 {
2085 struct symtab_and_line sal;
2086 struct breakpoint *b;
2087
2088 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
2089
2090 sal.pc = address;
2091 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
2092 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
2093
2094 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
2095 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2096 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
2097
2098 return b;
2099 }
2100
2101 static void
2102 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
2103 {
2104 struct objfile *objfile;
2105
2106 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2107 {
2108 struct breakpoint *b;
2109 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2110
2111 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2112 if (m == NULL)
2113 continue;
2114
2115 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2116 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2117 bp_overlay_event);
2118 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2119
2120 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
2121 {
2122 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
2123 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
2124 }
2125 else
2126 {
2127 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2128 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
2129 }
2130 }
2131 update_global_location_list (1);
2132 }
2133
2134 static void
2135 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
2136 {
2137 struct program_space *pspace;
2138 struct objfile *objfile;
2139 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2140
2141 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2142
2143 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2144 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2145 {
2146 struct breakpoint *b;
2147 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2148
2149 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
2150 continue;
2151
2152 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2153
2154 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2155 if (m == NULL)
2156 continue;
2157
2158 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2159 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2160 bp_longjmp_master);
2161 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2162 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2163 }
2164 update_global_location_list (1);
2165
2166 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2167 }
2168
2169 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. The actual function
2170 looked for is named FUNC_NAME. */
2171 static void
2172 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (const char *func_name)
2173 {
2174 struct program_space *pspace;
2175 struct objfile *objfile;
2176 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2177
2178 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2179
2180 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2181 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2182 {
2183 struct breakpoint *b;
2184 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2185
2186 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2187
2188 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
2189 if (m == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_text
2190 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_file_text))
2191 continue;
2192
2193 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2194 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2195 bp_std_terminate_master);
2196 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2197 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2198 }
2199 update_global_location_list (1);
2200
2201 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2202 }
2203
2204 void
2205 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
2206 {
2207 struct breakpoint *b;
2208 struct breakpoint *temp;
2209 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
2210
2211 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
2212 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
2213 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
2214 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
2215 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
2216 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
2217 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
2218 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
2219 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
2220 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
2221 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
2222
2223 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2224 {
2225 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
2226 continue;
2227
2228 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2229 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
2230 {
2231 delete_breakpoint (b);
2232 continue;
2233 }
2234
2235 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2236 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
2237 {
2238 delete_breakpoint (b);
2239 continue;
2240 }
2241
2242 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
2243 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
2244 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
2245 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
2246 {
2247 delete_breakpoint (b);
2248 continue;
2249 }
2250
2251 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
2252 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
2253 {
2254 delete_breakpoint (b);
2255 continue;
2256 }
2257
2258 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
2259 after an exec. */
2260 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
2261 {
2262 delete_breakpoint (b);
2263 continue;
2264 }
2265
2266 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
2267 {
2268 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
2269 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
2270 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
2271 a new method, and call this method from here. */
2272 continue;
2273 }
2274
2275 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
2276 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
2277 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
2278 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
2279 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
2280 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
2281
2282 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
2283 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
2284 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
2285 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
2286 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
2287 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
2288 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
2289
2290 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
2291 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
2292 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
2293 let finish_command delete it.
2294
2295 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
2296 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2297 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2298 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2299 solib breakpoints.) */
2300
2301 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2302 {
2303 continue;
2304 }
2305
2306 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2307 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2308 a.out. */
2309 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2310 {
2311 delete_breakpoint (b);
2312 continue;
2313 }
2314 }
2315 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2316 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
2317 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
2318 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
2319 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
2320 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
2321 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ("std::terminate()");
2322 }
2323
2324 int
2325 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2326 {
2327 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2328 int val = 0;
2329 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2330 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2331
2332 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2333 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2334
2335 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2336 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2337 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2338 {
2339 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2340 continue;
2341
2342 if (b->inserted)
2343 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2344 }
2345
2346 /* Detach single-step breakpoints as well. */
2347 detach_single_step_breakpoints ();
2348
2349 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2350 return val;
2351 }
2352
2353 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2354 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2355 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2356 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2357 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2358
2359 static int
2360 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2361 {
2362 int val;
2363
2364 /* B is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
2365 gdb_assert (b->owner != NULL);
2366
2367 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2368 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2369 return 0;
2370
2371 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2372 This should not ever happen. */
2373 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2374
2375 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2376 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2377 {
2378 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2379 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2380 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2381
2382 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2383 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2384 || b->section == NULL
2385 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2386 {
2387 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2388
2389 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2390 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2391 else
2392 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2393 }
2394 else
2395 {
2396 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2397 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2398 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2399 {
2400 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2401 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2402 */
2403 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2404 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2405 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2406 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2407 &b->overlay_target_info);
2408 else
2409 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2410 &b->overlay_target_info);
2411 }
2412 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2413 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2414 if (b->inserted)
2415 {
2416 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2417 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2418 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2419 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2420 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2421 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2422 &b->target_info);
2423
2424 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2425 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2426 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2427 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2428 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2429 &b->target_info);
2430 else
2431 val = 0;
2432 }
2433 else
2434 {
2435 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2436 val = 0;
2437 }
2438 }
2439
2440 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2441 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2442 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2443 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2444 val = 0;
2445
2446 if (val)
2447 return val;
2448 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2449 }
2450 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2451 {
2452 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2453 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2454 b->watchpoint_type, b->owner->cond_exp);
2455
2456 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2457 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2458 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2459 b->owner->number);
2460 }
2461 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2462 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2463 && !b->duplicate)
2464 {
2465 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2466
2467 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2468 if (val)
2469 return val;
2470 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2471 }
2472
2473 return 0;
2474 }
2475
2476 static int
2477 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2478 {
2479 int ret;
2480 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2481
2482 /* B is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
2483 gdb_assert (b->owner != NULL);
2484
2485 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2486 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2487 return 0;
2488
2489 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2490 This should not ever happen. */
2491 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2492
2493 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2494
2495 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2496
2497 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2498
2499 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2500 return ret;
2501 }
2502
2503 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2504
2505 void
2506 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2507 {
2508 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2509
2510 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2511 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2512 bpt->inserted = 0;
2513 }
2514
2515 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2516 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2517
2518 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2519 between runs.
2520
2521 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2522 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2523 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2524
2525
2526
2527 void
2528 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2529 {
2530 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2531 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2532 int ix;
2533 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2534
2535 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2536 nothing to do. */
2537 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2538 return;
2539
2540 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2541 {
2542 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BPT->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2543 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2544 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2545 bpt->inserted = 0;
2546 }
2547
2548 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2549 {
2550 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2551 continue;
2552
2553 switch (b->type)
2554 {
2555 case bp_call_dummy:
2556
2557 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2558 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2559 rid of it. */
2560
2561 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2562
2563 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2564
2565 case bp_shlib_event:
2566
2567 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2568 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2569 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2570 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2571 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2572
2573 (gdb) file prog-linux
2574 (gdb) run # native linux target
2575 ...
2576 (gdb) kill
2577 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2578 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2579 */
2580
2581 delete_breakpoint (b);
2582 break;
2583
2584 case bp_watchpoint:
2585 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2586 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2587 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2588
2589 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2590 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2591 delete_breakpoint (b);
2592 else if (context == inf_starting)
2593 {
2594 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2595 in insert_breakpoints. */
2596 if (b->val)
2597 value_free (b->val);
2598 b->val = NULL;
2599 b->val_valid = 0;
2600 }
2601 break;
2602 default:
2603 break;
2604 }
2605 }
2606
2607 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2608 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2609 free_bp_location (bpt);
2610 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2611 }
2612
2613 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2614 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2615 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2616 match, not program space. */
2617
2618 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2619 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2620 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2621 permanent breakpoint.
2622 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2623 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2624 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2625 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2626 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2627
2628 enum breakpoint_here
2629 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2630 {
2631 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2632 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2633
2634 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2635 {
2636 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2637 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2638 continue;
2639
2640 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BPT->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2641 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2642 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2643 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2644 aspace, pc))
2645 {
2646 if (overlay_debugging
2647 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2648 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2649 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2650 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2651 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2652 else
2653 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2654 }
2655 }
2656
2657 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2658 }
2659
2660 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2661
2662 int
2663 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2664 {
2665 struct bp_location *loc;
2666 int ix;
2667
2668 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2669 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2670 aspace, pc))
2671 return 1;
2672
2673 return 0;
2674 }
2675
2676 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2677 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2678 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2679 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2680
2681 int
2682 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2683 {
2684 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2685
2686 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2687 {
2688 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2689 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2690 continue;
2691
2692 if (bpt->inserted
2693 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2694 aspace, pc))
2695 {
2696 if (overlay_debugging
2697 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2698 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2699 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2700 else
2701 return 1;
2702 }
2703 }
2704 return 0;
2705 }
2706
2707 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2708 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2709
2710 int
2711 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2712 {
2713 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2714 return 1;
2715
2716 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2717 return 1;
2718
2719 return 0;
2720 }
2721
2722 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2723 inserted at PC. */
2724
2725 int
2726 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2727 {
2728 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2729
2730 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2731 {
2732 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2733 continue;
2734
2735 if (bpt->inserted
2736 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2737 aspace, pc))
2738 {
2739 if (overlay_debugging
2740 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2741 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2742 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2743 else
2744 return 1;
2745 }
2746 }
2747
2748 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2749 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2750 return 1;
2751
2752 return 0;
2753 }
2754
2755 int
2756 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2757 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2758 {
2759 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2760
2761 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2762 {
2763 struct bp_location *loc;
2764
2765 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2766 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2767 continue;
2768
2769 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2770 continue;
2771
2772 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2773 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2774 {
2775 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2776
2777 /* Check for intersection. */
2778 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2779 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2780 if (l < h)
2781 return 1;
2782 }
2783 }
2784 return 0;
2785 }
2786
2787 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2788 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2789
2790 int
2791 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2792 ptid_t ptid)
2793 {
2794 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2795 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2796 int thread = -1;
2797 int task = 0;
2798
2799 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2800 {
2801 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2802 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2803 continue;
2804
2805 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BPT->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2806 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2807 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2808 continue;
2809
2810 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2811 aspace, pc))
2812 continue;
2813
2814 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2815 {
2816 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2817 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2818 it is now time to do so. */
2819 if (thread == -1)
2820 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2821 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2822 continue;
2823 }
2824
2825 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2826 {
2827 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2828 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2829 it is now time to do so. */
2830 if (task == 0)
2831 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2832 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2833 continue;
2834 }
2835
2836 if (overlay_debugging
2837 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2838 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2839 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2840
2841 return 1;
2842 }
2843
2844 return 0;
2845 }
2846 \f
2847
2848 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2849 in breakpoint.h. */
2850
2851 int
2852 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2853 {
2854 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2855 }
2856
2857 void
2858 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2859 {
2860 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2861 value_free (bs->old_val);
2862 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
2863 xfree (bs);
2864 }
2865
2866 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2867 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2868
2869 void
2870 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2871 {
2872 bpstat p;
2873 bpstat q;
2874
2875 if (bsp == 0)
2876 return;
2877 p = *bsp;
2878 while (p != NULL)
2879 {
2880 q = p->next;
2881 bpstat_free (p);
2882 p = q;
2883 }
2884 *bsp = NULL;
2885 }
2886
2887 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2888 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2889
2890 bpstat
2891 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2892 {
2893 bpstat p = NULL;
2894 bpstat tmp;
2895 bpstat retval = NULL;
2896
2897 if (bs == NULL)
2898 return bs;
2899
2900 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2901 {
2902 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2903 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2904 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
2905 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2906 {
2907 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2908 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2909 }
2910
2911 if (p == NULL)
2912 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2913 retval = tmp;
2914 else
2915 p->next = tmp;
2916 p = tmp;
2917 }
2918 p->next = NULL;
2919 return retval;
2920 }
2921
2922 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2923
2924 bpstat
2925 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2926 {
2927 if (bsp == NULL)
2928 return NULL;
2929
2930 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2931 {
2932 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2933 return bsp;
2934 }
2935 return NULL;
2936 }
2937
2938 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2939 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2940 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2941 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2942 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2943 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2944 we set it.
2945 Return 1 otherwise. */
2946
2947 int
2948 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2949 {
2950 struct breakpoint *b;
2951
2952 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2953 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2954
2955 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2956 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2957 this function might return the same number more
2958 than once and this will look ugly. */
2959 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2960 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2961 if (b == NULL)
2962 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2963
2964 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2965 return 1;
2966 }
2967
2968 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2969
2970 void
2971 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2972 {
2973 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2974 {
2975 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
2976 bs->commands_left = NULL;
2977 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2978 {
2979 value_free (bs->old_val);
2980 bs->old_val = NULL;
2981 }
2982 }
2983 }
2984
2985 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2986
2987 static void
2988 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2989 {
2990 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2991 {
2992 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2993
2994 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2995 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2996 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2997 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2998 if (tp->in_infcall)
2999 return;
3000 }
3001
3002 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
3003 }
3004
3005 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
3006 static void
3007 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
3008 {
3009 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
3010 }
3011
3012 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
3013 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
3014 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
3015 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
3016
3017 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
3018 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
3019 bpstat of the current thread. */
3020
3021 static int
3022 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
3023 {
3024 bpstat bs;
3025 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3026 int again = 0;
3027
3028 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
3029 in bs->commands. */
3030 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
3031 return 0;
3032
3033 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
3034 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
3035
3036 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
3037 bs = *bsp;
3038
3039 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
3040 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3041 {
3042 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
3043 struct command_line *cmd;
3044 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
3045
3046 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
3047
3048 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
3049 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
3050 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
3051 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
3052 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
3053 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
3054 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
3055 the tree when we're done. */
3056 ccmd = bs->commands;
3057 bs->commands = NULL;
3058 this_cmd_tree_chain
3059 = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
3060 cmd = bs->commands_left;
3061 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3062
3063 while (cmd != NULL)
3064 {
3065 execute_control_command (cmd);
3066
3067 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
3068 break;
3069 else
3070 cmd = cmd->next;
3071 }
3072
3073 /* We can free this command tree now. */
3074 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
3075
3076 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
3077 {
3078 if (target_can_async_p ())
3079 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
3080 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
3081 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
3082 ;
3083 else
3084 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
3085 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
3086 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
3087 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
3088 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
3089 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
3090 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
3091 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
3092 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
3093 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
3094 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
3095 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
3096 with the new stop_bpstat. */
3097 again = 1;
3098 break;
3099 }
3100 }
3101 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3102 return again;
3103 }
3104
3105 void
3106 bpstat_do_actions (void)
3107 {
3108 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
3109 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
3110 && target_has_execution
3111 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
3112 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
3113 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
3114 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
3115 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
3116 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
3117 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
3118 break;
3119 }
3120
3121 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
3122
3123 static void
3124 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
3125 {
3126 if (val == NULL)
3127 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
3128 else
3129 {
3130 struct value_print_options opts;
3131 get_user_print_options (&opts);
3132 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
3133 }
3134 }
3135
3136 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
3137 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
3138 by having it set different print_it values.
3139
3140 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
3141 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
3142 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
3143 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
3144 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
3145
3146 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
3147 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
3148 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
3149 don't print anything else.
3150 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
3151 that something to be followed by a location.
3152 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
3153 that something to be followed by a location.
3154 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
3155 analysis. */
3156
3157 static enum print_stop_action
3158 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
3159 {
3160 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3161 struct breakpoint *b;
3162 const struct bp_location *bl;
3163 struct ui_stream *stb;
3164 int bp_temp = 0;
3165 enum print_stop_action result;
3166
3167 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
3168 which has since been deleted. */
3169 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3170 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3171 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3172
3173 /* bl->owner can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
3174 which has since been placed into moribund_locations. */
3175 if (bl->owner == NULL)
3176 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3177 b = bl->owner;
3178
3179 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
3180 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
3181
3182 switch (b->type)
3183 {
3184 case bp_breakpoint:
3185 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3186 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
3187 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
3188 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
3189 bl->address,
3190 b->number, 1);
3191 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
3192 if (bp_temp)
3193 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
3194 else
3195 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
3196 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3197 {
3198 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
3199 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
3200 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
3201 }
3202 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
3203 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
3204 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3205 break;
3206
3207 case bp_shlib_event:
3208 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
3209 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
3210 to shlib event" message.) */
3211 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
3212 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3213 break;
3214
3215 case bp_thread_event:
3216 /* Not sure how we will get here.
3217 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
3218 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3219 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3220 break;
3221
3222 case bp_overlay_event:
3223 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
3224 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3225 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3226 break;
3227
3228 case bp_longjmp_master:
3229 /* These should never be enabled. */
3230 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3231 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3232 break;
3233
3234 case bp_std_terminate_master:
3235 /* These should never be enabled. */
3236 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3237 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3238 break;
3239
3240 case bp_watchpoint:
3241 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3242 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3243 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3244 ui_out_field_string
3245 (uiout, "reason",
3246 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3247 mention (b);
3248 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3249 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3250 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3251 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3252 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3253 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3254 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3255 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3256 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
3257 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3258 break;
3259
3260 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3261 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3262 ui_out_field_string
3263 (uiout, "reason",
3264 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3265 mention (b);
3266 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3267 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3268 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3269 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
3270 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3271 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3272 break;
3273
3274 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3275 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3276 {
3277 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3278 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3279 ui_out_field_string
3280 (uiout, "reason",
3281 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3282 mention (b);
3283 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3284 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3285 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3286 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3287 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3288 }
3289 else
3290 {
3291 mention (b);
3292 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3293 ui_out_field_string
3294 (uiout, "reason",
3295 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3296 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3297 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3298 }
3299 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3300 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3301 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3302 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3303 break;
3304
3305 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3306 here. */
3307
3308 case bp_finish:
3309 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3310 ui_out_field_string
3311 (uiout, "reason",
3312 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3313 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3314 break;
3315
3316 case bp_until:
3317 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3318 ui_out_field_string
3319 (uiout, "reason",
3320 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3321 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3322 break;
3323
3324 case bp_none:
3325 case bp_longjmp:
3326 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3327 case bp_step_resume:
3328 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3329 case bp_call_dummy:
3330 case bp_std_terminate:
3331 case bp_tracepoint:
3332 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3333 case bp_jit_event:
3334 default:
3335 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3336 break;
3337 }
3338
3339 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3340 return result;
3341 }
3342
3343 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3344 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3345 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3346 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3347 normal_stop(). */
3348
3349 static enum print_stop_action
3350 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3351 {
3352 switch (bs->print_it)
3353 {
3354 case print_it_noop:
3355 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3356 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3357 break;
3358
3359 case print_it_done:
3360 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3361 relevant messages. */
3362 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3363 break;
3364
3365 case print_it_normal:
3366 {
3367 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3368 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3369
3370 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3371 print_it_typical. */
3372 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3373 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3374 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3375 else
3376 return print_it_typical (bs);
3377 }
3378 break;
3379
3380 default:
3381 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3382 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3383 break;
3384 }
3385 }
3386
3387 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3388 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3389 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3390 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3391 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3392 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3393 routine is one of:
3394
3395 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3396 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3397 code to print the location. An example is
3398 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3399 the location.
3400 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3401 to also print the location part of the message.
3402 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3403 don't require a location appended to the end.
3404 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3405 further info to be printed.*/
3406
3407 enum print_stop_action
3408 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3409 {
3410 int val;
3411
3412 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3413 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3414 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3415 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3416 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3417 {
3418 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3419 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3420 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3421 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3422 return val;
3423 }
3424
3425 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3426 with and nothing was printed. */
3427 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3428 }
3429
3430 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3431 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3432 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3433 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3434
3435 static int
3436 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3437 {
3438 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3439 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3440
3441 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3442 return i;
3443 }
3444
3445 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3446
3447 static bpstat
3448 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3449 {
3450 bpstat bs;
3451
3452 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3453 cbs->next = bs;
3454 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3455 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3456 bs->commands = NULL;
3457 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3458 bs->old_val = NULL;
3459 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3460 return bs;
3461 }
3462 \f
3463 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3464 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3465
3466 int
3467 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3468 {
3469 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3470 CORE_ADDR addr;
3471 struct breakpoint *b;
3472
3473 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3474 {
3475 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3476 as not triggered. */
3477 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3478 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3479 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3480
3481 return 0;
3482 }
3483
3484 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3485 {
3486 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3487 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3488 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3489 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3490 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3491
3492 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3493 }
3494
3495 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3496 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3497 triggered. */
3498
3499 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3500 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3501 {
3502 struct bp_location *loc;
3503
3504 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3505 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3506 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3507 sufficient. */
3508 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3509 addr, loc->address,
3510 loc->length))
3511 {
3512 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3513 break;
3514 }
3515 }
3516
3517 return 1;
3518 }
3519
3520 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3521 because of check_errors). */
3522 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3523 #define WP_DELETED 1
3524 /* The value has changed. */
3525 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3526 /* The value has not changed. */
3527 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3528 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
3529 #define WP_IGNORE 4
3530
3531 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3532 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3533
3534 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3535
3536 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3537 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3538
3539 static int
3540 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3541 {
3542 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3543 struct breakpoint *b;
3544 struct frame_info *fr;
3545 int within_current_scope;
3546
3547 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
3548 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
3549 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at->owner != NULL);
3550 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3551
3552 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3553 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3554 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3555 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3556 return WP_IGNORE;
3557
3558 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3559 within_current_scope = 1;
3560 else
3561 {
3562 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3563 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3564 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3565
3566 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3567 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3568 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3569 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3570 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3571 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3572 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3573 is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3574 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3575 return WP_IGNORE;
3576
3577 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3578 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3579
3580 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3581 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3582 if (within_current_scope)
3583 {
3584 struct symbol *function;
3585
3586 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3587 if (function == NULL
3588 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3589 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3590 within_current_scope = 0;
3591 }
3592
3593 if (within_current_scope)
3594 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3595 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3596 the user. */
3597 select_frame (fr);
3598 }
3599
3600 if (within_current_scope)
3601 {
3602 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3603 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3604 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3605 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3606
3607 int pc = 0;
3608 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3609 struct value *new_val;
3610
3611 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3612
3613 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3614 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3615 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3616 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3617 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3618 {
3619 if (new_val != NULL)
3620 {
3621 release_value (new_val);
3622 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3623 }
3624 bs->old_val = b->val;
3625 b->val = new_val;
3626 b->val_valid = 1;
3627 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3628 }
3629 else
3630 {
3631 /* Nothing changed. */
3632 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3633 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3634 }
3635 }
3636 else
3637 {
3638 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3639 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3640 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3641 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3642 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3643 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3644 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3645 the first value assigned). */
3646 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3647 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3648 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3649 information here. */
3650 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3651 ui_out_field_string
3652 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3653 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3654 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3655 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3656 which its expression is valid.\n");
3657
3658 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3659 {
3660 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3661 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3662 b->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3663 }
3664 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3665
3666 return WP_DELETED;
3667 }
3668 }
3669
3670 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3671 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3672 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3673 static int
3674 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3675 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3676 {
3677 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3678
3679 /* BL is from existing struct breakpoint. */
3680 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3681
3682 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3683 tracepoints. */
3684 if (is_tracepoint (b))
3685 return 0;
3686
3687 if (!is_watchpoint (b)
3688 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3689 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3690 {
3691 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3692 aspace, bp_addr))
3693 return 0;
3694 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3695 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3696 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3697 return 0;
3698 }
3699
3700 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3701 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3702 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3703 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3704 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3705 (did not match the data address). */
3706
3707 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
3708 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3709 return 0;
3710
3711 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3712 {
3713 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3714 return 0;
3715 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3716 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3717 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3718 return 0;
3719 }
3720
3721 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3722 {
3723 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3724 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3725 return 0;
3726 }
3727
3728 return 1;
3729 }
3730
3731 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3732 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3733 to 0. */
3734 static void
3735 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3736 {
3737 const struct bp_location *bl;
3738 struct breakpoint *b;
3739
3740 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
3741 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3742 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
3743 b = bl->owner;
3744 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3745
3746 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3747 {
3748 int must_check_value = 0;
3749
3750 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3751 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3752 watched value. */
3753 must_check_value = 1;
3754 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3755 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3756 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3757 this watchpoint. */
3758 must_check_value = 1;
3759 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3760 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3761 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3762 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3763 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3764 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3765 must_check_value = 1;
3766
3767 if (must_check_value)
3768 {
3769 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3770 b->number);
3771 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3772 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3773 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3774 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3775 switch (e)
3776 {
3777 case WP_DELETED:
3778 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3779 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3780 /* Stop. */
3781 break;
3782 case WP_IGNORE:
3783 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3784 bs->stop = 0;
3785 break;
3786 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3787 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3788 {
3789 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3790
3791 1. we're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3792 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3793 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3794 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3795 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3796 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3797 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3798 old value.
3799
3800 2. we're watching the triggered memory for both
3801 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3802 happen:
3803
3804 2.1. this is a target that can't break on data
3805 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3806 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3807 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3808
3809 2.2. otherwise, the target supports read
3810 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3811 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3812 watchpoint.
3813
3814 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3815 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3816 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3817 changes. This still gives false positives when
3818 the program writes the same value to memory as
3819 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3820 it for a read), but it's much better than
3821 nothing. */
3822
3823 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3824
3825 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3826 {
3827 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3828
3829 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3830 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3831 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3832 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3833 == watch_triggered_yes))
3834 {
3835 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3836 break;
3837 }
3838 }
3839
3840 if (other_write_watchpoint
3841 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
3842 {
3843 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
3844 and the value changed since the last time we
3845 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
3846 Ignore it. */
3847 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3848 bs->stop = 0;
3849 }
3850 }
3851 break;
3852 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3853 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3854 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3855 {
3856 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3857 the value hasn't changed. */
3858 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3859 bs->stop = 0;
3860 }
3861 /* Stop. */
3862 break;
3863 default:
3864 /* Can't happen. */
3865 case 0:
3866 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3867 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3868 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3869 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3870 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3871 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3872 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3873 break;
3874 }
3875 }
3876 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3877 {
3878 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3879 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3880 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3881 anything for this watchpoint. */
3882 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3883 bs->stop = 0;
3884 }
3885 }
3886 }
3887
3888
3889 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3890 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3891 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3892 static void
3893 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3894 {
3895 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3896 const struct bp_location *bl;
3897 struct breakpoint *b;
3898
3899 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
3900 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3901 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
3902 b = bl->owner;
3903 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3904
3905 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3906 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3907 bs->stop = 0;
3908 else if (bs->stop)
3909 {
3910 int value_is_zero = 0;
3911 struct expression *cond;
3912
3913 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3914 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3915 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3916 iteration. */
3917 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3918 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3919
3920 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3921 cond = b->cond_exp;
3922 else
3923 cond = bl->cond;
3924
3925 if (cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3926 {
3927 int within_current_scope = 1;
3928
3929 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3930 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3931 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3932 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3933 function call. */
3934 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3935
3936 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3937 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3938 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3939 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3940 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3941 call site. */
3942 if (!is_watchpoint (b) || b->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
3943 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3944 else
3945 {
3946 struct frame_info *frame;
3947
3948 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
3949 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
3950 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
3951 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
3952 really matter which instantiation of the function
3953 where the condition makes sense triggers the
3954 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
3955 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
3956 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
3957 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
3958 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
3959 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
3960 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
3961 intuitive. */
3962 frame = block_innermost_frame (b->cond_exp_valid_block);
3963 if (frame != NULL)
3964 select_frame (frame);
3965 else
3966 within_current_scope = 0;
3967 }
3968 if (within_current_scope)
3969 value_is_zero
3970 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
3971 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3972 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3973 else
3974 {
3975 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
3976 "in the current scope"));
3977 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
3978 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
3979 value_is_zero = 0;
3980 }
3981 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3982 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3983 }
3984
3985 if (cond && value_is_zero)
3986 {
3987 bs->stop = 0;
3988 }
3989 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3990 {
3991 bs->stop = 0;
3992 }
3993 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3994 {
3995 b->ignore_count--;
3996 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3997 bs->stop = 0;
3998 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3999 stop. */
4000 ++(b->hit_count);
4001 }
4002 }
4003 }
4004
4005
4006 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
4007 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
4008
4009 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
4010 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
4011
4012 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
4013
4014 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
4015
4016 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
4017 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
4018 several reasons concurrently.)
4019
4020 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
4021 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
4022
4023 bpstat
4024 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
4025 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
4026 {
4027 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
4028 struct bp_location *bl;
4029 struct bp_location *loc;
4030 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
4031 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
4032 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
4033 bpstat bs = root_bs;
4034 int ix;
4035 int need_remove_insert;
4036
4037 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
4038 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
4039 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
4040
4041 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4042 {
4043 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4044 continue;
4045
4046 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
4047 {
4048 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
4049 The watchpoint_check function will work on the entire expression,
4050 not the individual locations. For read watchpoints, the
4051 watchpoints_triggered function has checked all locations
4052 already. */
4053 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
4054 break;
4055
4056 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
4057 continue;
4058
4059 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
4060 continue;
4061
4062 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
4063
4064 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
4065
4066 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
4067 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
4068 'stop' to 0. */
4069 bs->stop = 1;
4070 bs->print = 1;
4071
4072 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
4073 if (!bs->stop)
4074 continue;
4075
4076 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
4077 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master
4078 || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
4079 /* We do not stop for these. */
4080 bs->stop = 0;
4081 else
4082 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
4083
4084 if (bs->stop)
4085 {
4086 ++(b->hit_count);
4087
4088 /* We will stop here */
4089 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
4090 {
4091 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4092 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
4093 update_global_location_list (0);
4094 }
4095 if (b->silent)
4096 bs->print = 0;
4097 bs->commands = b->commands;
4098 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
4099 bs->commands_left = bs->commands ? bs->commands->commands : NULL;
4100 if (bs->commands_left
4101 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands_left->line) == 0
4102 || (xdb_commands
4103 && strcmp ("Q",
4104 bs->commands_left->line) == 0)))
4105 {
4106 bs->commands_left = bs->commands_left->next;
4107 bs->print = 0;
4108 }
4109 }
4110
4111 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
4112 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
4113 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4114 }
4115 }
4116
4117 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4118 {
4119 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
4120 aspace, bp_addr))
4121 {
4122 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
4123 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
4124 bs->stop = 0;
4125 bs->print = 0;
4126 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4127 }
4128 }
4129
4130 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
4131
4132 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
4133 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
4134 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
4135 done later. */
4136 need_remove_insert = 0;
4137 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (root_bs->next))
4138 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4139 if (!bs->stop
4140 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
4141 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
4142 {
4143 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
4144 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
4145 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
4146 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
4147 need_remove_insert = 1;
4148 }
4149
4150 if (need_remove_insert)
4151 update_global_location_list (1);
4152
4153 return root_bs->next;
4154 }
4155
4156 static void
4157 handle_jit_event (void)
4158 {
4159 struct frame_info *frame;
4160 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
4161
4162 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
4163 breakpoint_re_set. */
4164 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
4165
4166 frame = get_current_frame ();
4167 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4168
4169 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
4170
4171 target_terminal_inferior ();
4172 }
4173
4174 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
4175
4176 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
4177
4178 struct bpstat_what
4179 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
4180 {
4181 struct bpstat_what retval;
4182 /* We need to defer calling `solib_add', as adding new symbols
4183 resets breakpoints, which in turn deletes breakpoint locations,
4184 and hence may clear unprocessed entries in the BS chain. */
4185 int shlib_event = 0;
4186 int jit_event = 0;
4187
4188 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4189 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
4190
4191 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4192 {
4193 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
4194 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
4195 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4196 enum bptype bptype;
4197
4198 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4199 {
4200 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
4201 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
4202 bptype = bp_none;
4203 }
4204 else if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
4205 bptype = bp_none;
4206 else
4207 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type;
4208
4209 switch (bptype)
4210 {
4211 case bp_none:
4212 break;
4213 case bp_breakpoint:
4214 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4215 case bp_until:
4216 case bp_finish:
4217 if (bs->stop)
4218 {
4219 if (bs->print)
4220 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4221 else
4222 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4223 }
4224 else
4225 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4226 break;
4227 case bp_watchpoint:
4228 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4229 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4230 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4231 if (bs->stop)
4232 {
4233 if (bs->print)
4234 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4235 else
4236 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4237 }
4238 else
4239 {
4240 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4241 This requires no further action. */
4242 }
4243 break;
4244 case bp_longjmp:
4245 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
4246 break;
4247 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4248 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
4249 break;
4250 case bp_step_resume:
4251 if (bs->stop)
4252 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
4253 else
4254 {
4255 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
4256 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4257 }
4258 break;
4259 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4260 case bp_thread_event:
4261 case bp_overlay_event:
4262 case bp_longjmp_master:
4263 case bp_std_terminate_master:
4264 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4265 break;
4266 case bp_catchpoint:
4267 if (bs->stop)
4268 {
4269 if (bs->print)
4270 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4271 else
4272 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4273 }
4274 else
4275 {
4276 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4277 This requires no further action. */
4278 }
4279 break;
4280 case bp_shlib_event:
4281 shlib_event = 1;
4282
4283 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB
4284 of events. This allows the user to get control and place
4285 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically
4286 loaded objects (among other things). */
4287 if (stop_on_solib_events)
4288 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4289 else
4290 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4291 break;
4292 case bp_jit_event:
4293 jit_event = 1;
4294 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4295 break;
4296 case bp_call_dummy:
4297 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4298 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4299 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
4300 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4301 break;
4302 case bp_std_terminate:
4303 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4304 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4305 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
4306 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4307 break;
4308 case bp_tracepoint:
4309 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4310 case bp_static_tracepoint:
4311 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4312 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4313 out already. */
4314 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4315 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4316 default:
4317 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4318 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
4319 }
4320
4321 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
4322 }
4323
4324 if (shlib_event)
4325 {
4326 if (debug_infrun)
4327 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_shlib_event\n");
4328
4329 /* Check for any newly added shared libraries if we're supposed
4330 to be adding them automatically. */
4331
4332 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
4333 breakpoint_re_set. */
4334 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
4335
4336 #ifdef SOLIB_ADD
4337 SOLIB_ADD (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
4338 #else
4339 solib_add (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
4340 #endif
4341
4342 target_terminal_inferior ();
4343 }
4344
4345 if (jit_event)
4346 {
4347 if (debug_infrun)
4348 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
4349
4350 handle_jit_event ();
4351 }
4352
4353 return retval;
4354 }
4355
4356 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4357 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4358 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4359
4360 int
4361 bpstat_should_step (void)
4362 {
4363 struct breakpoint *b;
4364
4365 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4366 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4367 return 1;
4368 return 0;
4369 }
4370
4371 int
4372 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4373 {
4374 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4375 if (bs->stop)
4376 return 1;
4377
4378 return 0;
4379 }
4380
4381 \f
4382
4383 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4384
4385 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4386 struct bp_location *loc,
4387 char *wrap_indent,
4388 struct ui_stream *stb)
4389 {
4390 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4391
4392 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4393 loc = NULL;
4394
4395 if (loc != NULL)
4396 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4397
4398 if (b->source_file && loc)
4399 {
4400 struct symbol *sym
4401 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4402 if (sym)
4403 {
4404 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4405 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4406 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4407 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
4408 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
4409 }
4410 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4411 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4412
4413 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4414 {
4415 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4416 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4417
4418 if (fullname)
4419 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4420 }
4421
4422 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4423 }
4424 else if (loc)
4425 {
4426 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4427 demangle, "");
4428 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4429 }
4430 else
4431 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4432
4433 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4434 }
4435
4436 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4437 static void
4438 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4439 struct bp_location *loc,
4440 int loc_number,
4441 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4442 int print_address_bits,
4443 int allflag)
4444 {
4445 struct command_line *l;
4446 struct ep_type_description
4447 {
4448 enum bptype type;
4449 char *description;
4450 };
4451 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4452 {
4453 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4454 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4455 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4456 {bp_until, "until"},
4457 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4458 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4459 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4460 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4461 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4462 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4463 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4464 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4465 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4466 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4467 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
4468 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4469 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4470 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4471 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4472 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
4473 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4474 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4475 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4476 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
4477 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4478 };
4479
4480 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4481 char wrap_indent[80];
4482 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4483 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4484 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4485
4486 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4487 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4488 struct value_print_options opts;
4489
4490 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4491
4492 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4493 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4494 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4495 location. */
4496 if (loc == NULL
4497 && (b->loc != NULL
4498 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4499 header_of_multiple = 1;
4500 if (loc == NULL)
4501 loc = b->loc;
4502
4503 annotate_record ();
4504 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4505
4506 /* 1 */
4507 annotate_field (0);
4508 if (part_of_multiple)
4509 {
4510 char *formatted;
4511 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4512 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4513 xfree (formatted);
4514 }
4515 else
4516 {
4517 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4518 }
4519
4520 /* 2 */
4521 annotate_field (1);
4522 if (part_of_multiple)
4523 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4524 else
4525 {
4526 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4527 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4528 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4529 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4530 (int) b->type);
4531 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4532 }
4533
4534 /* 3 */
4535 annotate_field (2);
4536 if (part_of_multiple)
4537 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4538 else
4539 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4540
4541
4542 /* 4 */
4543 annotate_field (3);
4544 if (part_of_multiple)
4545 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4546 else
4547 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4548 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4549 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4550
4551
4552 /* 5 and 6 */
4553 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4554 if (opts.addressprint)
4555 {
4556 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4557 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4558 else
4559 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4560 }
4561
4562 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4563 {
4564 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4565 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4566 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4567 just one location. */
4568 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4569 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4570 }
4571 else
4572 switch (b->type)
4573 {
4574 case bp_none:
4575 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4576 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4577 break;
4578
4579 case bp_watchpoint:
4580 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4581 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4582 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4583 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4584 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4585 is relatively readable). */
4586 if (opts.addressprint)
4587 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4588 annotate_field (5);
4589 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4590 break;
4591
4592 case bp_breakpoint:
4593 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4594 case bp_until:
4595 case bp_finish:
4596 case bp_longjmp:
4597 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4598 case bp_step_resume:
4599 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4600 case bp_call_dummy:
4601 case bp_std_terminate:
4602 case bp_shlib_event:
4603 case bp_thread_event:
4604 case bp_overlay_event:
4605 case bp_longjmp_master:
4606 case bp_std_terminate_master:
4607 case bp_tracepoint:
4608 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4609 case bp_static_tracepoint:
4610 case bp_jit_event:
4611 if (opts.addressprint)
4612 {
4613 annotate_field (4);
4614 if (header_of_multiple)
4615 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4616 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4617 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4618 else
4619 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4620 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4621 }
4622 annotate_field (5);
4623 if (!header_of_multiple)
4624 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4625 if (b->loc)
4626 *last_loc = b->loc;
4627 break;
4628 }
4629
4630
4631 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4632 are several. */
4633 if (loc != NULL
4634 && !header_of_multiple
4635 && (allflag
4636 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4637 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4638 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4639 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in moribund_locations and
4640 thus having NULL OWNER. */
4641 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4642 {
4643 struct inferior *inf;
4644 int first = 1;
4645
4646 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4647 {
4648 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4649 {
4650 if (first)
4651 {
4652 first = 0;
4653 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4654 }
4655 else
4656 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4657 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4658 }
4659 }
4660 }
4661
4662 if (!part_of_multiple)
4663 {
4664 if (b->thread != -1)
4665 {
4666 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4667 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4668 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4669 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4670 }
4671 else if (b->task != 0)
4672 {
4673 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4674 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4675 }
4676 }
4677
4678 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4679
4680 if (!part_of_multiple && b->static_trace_marker_id)
4681 {
4682 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
4683
4684 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
4685 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
4686 b->static_trace_marker_id);
4687 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4688 }
4689
4690 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4691 {
4692 annotate_field (6);
4693 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4694 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4695 the frame ID. */
4696 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4697 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4698 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4699 }
4700
4701 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4702 {
4703 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4704 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4705 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4706 annotate_field (7);
4707 if (is_tracepoint (b))
4708 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4709 else
4710 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4711 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4712 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4713 }
4714
4715 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4716 {
4717 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4718 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4719 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4720 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4721 }
4722
4723 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4724 {
4725 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4726 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4727 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4728 else
4729 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4730 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4731 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4732 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4733 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4734 else
4735 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4736 }
4737
4738 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4739 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4740 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4741 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4742 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4743
4744 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4745 {
4746 annotate_field (8);
4747 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4748 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4749 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4750 }
4751
4752 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
4753 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4754 {
4755 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4756
4757 annotate_field (9);
4758 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4759 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4760 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4761 }
4762
4763 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4764 {
4765 annotate_field (10);
4766 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4767 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4768 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4769 }
4770
4771 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4772 {
4773 if (b->addr_string)
4774 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4775 else if (b->exp_string)
4776 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4777 }
4778
4779 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4780 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4781 }
4782
4783 static void
4784 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4785 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4786 int allflag)
4787 {
4788 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4789 print_address_bits, allflag);
4790
4791 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4792 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4793 locations, if any. */
4794 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4795 {
4796 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4797 disabled, we print it as if it had
4798 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4799 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4800 situation.
4801 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4802 several locations internally, that's no a property
4803 exposed to user. */
4804 if (b->loc
4805 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4806 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4807 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4808 {
4809 struct bp_location *loc;
4810 int n = 1;
4811 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4812 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4813 print_address_bits, allflag);
4814 }
4815 }
4816 }
4817
4818 static int
4819 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4820 {
4821 int print_address_bits = 0;
4822 struct bp_location *loc;
4823
4824 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4825 {
4826 int addr_bit;
4827
4828 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
4829 an address to print. */
4830 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
4831 continue;
4832
4833 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4834 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4835 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4836 }
4837
4838 return print_address_bits;
4839 }
4840
4841 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4842 {
4843 int bnum;
4844 };
4845
4846 static int
4847 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4848 {
4849 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4850 struct breakpoint *b;
4851 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4852
4853 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4854 {
4855 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4856 {
4857 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4858
4859 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4860 return GDB_RC_OK;
4861 }
4862 }
4863 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4864 }
4865
4866 enum gdb_rc
4867 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4868 {
4869 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4870
4871 args.bnum = bnum;
4872 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4873 an error. */
4874 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4875 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4876 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4877 else
4878 return GDB_RC_OK;
4879 }
4880
4881 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4882 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4883
4884 static int
4885 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4886 {
4887 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4888 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4889 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4890 || is_tracepoint (b)
4891 || is_watchpoint (b));
4892 }
4893
4894 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4895 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
4896 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
4897 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
4898 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
4899 breakpoints listed. */
4900
4901 static int
4902 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag, int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
4903 {
4904 struct breakpoint *b;
4905 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4906 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4907 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4908 struct value_print_options opts;
4909 int print_address_bits = 0;
4910
4911 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4912
4913 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4914 size required for address fields. */
4915 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4916 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4917 if (bnum == -1
4918 || bnum == b->number)
4919 {
4920 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
4921 if (filter && !filter (b))
4922 continue;
4923
4924 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4925 {
4926 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4927 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4928 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4929
4930 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4931 }
4932 }
4933
4934 if (opts.addressprint)
4935 bkpttbl_chain
4936 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4937 "BreakpointTable");
4938 else
4939 bkpttbl_chain
4940 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4941 "BreakpointTable");
4942
4943 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4944 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4945 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4946 annotate_field (0);
4947 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4948 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4949 annotate_field (1);
4950 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4951 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4952 annotate_field (2);
4953 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4954 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4955 annotate_field (3);
4956 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4957 if (opts.addressprint)
4958 {
4959 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4960 annotate_field (4);
4961 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4962 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4963 else
4964 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4965 }
4966 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4967 annotate_field (5);
4968 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4969 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4970 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4971 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4972
4973 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4974 {
4975 QUIT;
4976 if (bnum == -1
4977 || bnum == b->number)
4978 {
4979 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
4980 if (filter && !filter (b))
4981 continue;
4982
4983 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4984 allflag is set. */
4985 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4986 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4987 }
4988 }
4989
4990 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4991
4992 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4993 {
4994 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report empty list. */
4995 if (!filter)
4996 {
4997 if (bnum == -1)
4998 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4999 else
5000 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
5001 bnum);
5002 }
5003 }
5004 else
5005 {
5006 if (last_loc && !server_command)
5007 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
5008 }
5009
5010 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
5011 there have been breakpoints? */
5012 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
5013
5014 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
5015 }
5016
5017 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
5018 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
5019
5020 static void
5021 default_collect_info (void)
5022 {
5023 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
5024 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
5025 not wanted. */
5026 if (!*default_collect)
5027 return;
5028
5029 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
5030 actions. */
5031 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
5032 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
5033 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
5034 }
5035
5036 static void
5037 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
5038 {
5039 int bnum = -1;
5040
5041 if (bnum_exp)
5042 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
5043
5044 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0, NULL);
5045
5046 default_collect_info ();
5047 }
5048
5049 static void
5050 watchpoints_info (char *wpnum_exp, int from_tty)
5051 {
5052 int wpnum = -1, num_printed;
5053
5054 if (wpnum_exp)
5055 wpnum = parse_and_eval_long (wpnum_exp);
5056
5057 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (wpnum, 0, is_watchpoint);
5058
5059 if (num_printed == 0)
5060 {
5061 if (wpnum == -1)
5062 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
5063 else
5064 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint number %d.\n", wpnum);
5065 }
5066 }
5067
5068 static void
5069 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
5070 {
5071 int bnum = -1;
5072
5073 if (bnum_exp)
5074 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
5075
5076 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1, NULL);
5077
5078 default_collect_info ();
5079 }
5080
5081 static int
5082 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
5083 struct program_space *pspace,
5084 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
5085 {
5086 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
5087
5088 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
5089 {
5090 if (bl->pspace == pspace
5091 && bl->address == pc
5092 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
5093 return 1;
5094 }
5095 return 0;
5096 }
5097
5098 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
5099 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
5100 address spaces. */
5101
5102 static void
5103 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5104 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
5105 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
5106 {
5107 int others = 0;
5108 struct breakpoint *b;
5109
5110 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5111 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
5112 if (others > 0)
5113 {
5114 if (others == 1)
5115 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
5116 else /* if (others == ???) */
5117 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
5118 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5119 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
5120 {
5121 others--;
5122 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
5123 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
5124 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
5125 else if (b->thread != -1)
5126 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
5127 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
5128 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
5129 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
5130 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5131 ? " (disabled)"
5132 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
5133 ? " (permanent)"
5134 : ""),
5135 (others > 1) ? ","
5136 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
5137 }
5138 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
5139 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
5140 printf_filtered (".\n");
5141 }
5142 }
5143 \f
5144 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
5145 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
5146
5147 void
5148 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
5149 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
5150 int line)
5151 {
5152 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
5153 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
5154 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
5155 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
5156 default_breakpoint_line = line;
5157 }
5158
5159 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
5160 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
5161 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
5162 (or use it for any other purpose either).
5163
5164 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
5165 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
5166 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
5167
5168 bp_watchpoint
5169 bp_catchpoint
5170
5171 */
5172
5173 static int
5174 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5175 {
5176 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
5177
5178 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
5179 }
5180
5181 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
5182 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
5183
5184 static int
5185 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
5186 {
5187 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
5188 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
5189 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
5190
5191 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware, then we
5192 we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at the same place.
5193 Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when the condition of whichever
5194 watchpoint was inserted evaluates to true, not giving a chance for GDB to
5195 check the condition of the other watchpoint. */
5196 if ((loc1->owner->cond_exp
5197 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address, loc1->length,
5198 loc1->watchpoint_type,
5199 loc1->owner->cond_exp))
5200 || (loc2->owner->cond_exp
5201 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address, loc2->length,
5202 loc2->watchpoint_type,
5203 loc2->owner->cond_exp)))
5204 return 0;
5205
5206 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
5207 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
5208 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
5209 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
5210 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
5211 become hw_access locations later. */
5212 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
5213 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
5214 && loc1->address == loc2->address
5215 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
5216 }
5217
5218 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
5219 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
5220 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
5221 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
5222
5223 static int
5224 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
5225 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
5226 {
5227 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
5228 || aspace1 == aspace2)
5229 && addr1 == addr2);
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
5233 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
5234 represent the same location. */
5235
5236 static int
5237 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
5238 {
5239 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
5240
5241 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
5242 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
5243 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
5244
5245 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
5246 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
5247
5248 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
5249 return 0;
5250 else if (hw_point1)
5251 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
5252 else
5253 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
5254 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
5255 }
5256
5257 static void
5258 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
5259 int bnum, int have_bnum)
5260 {
5261 char astr1[40];
5262 char astr2[40];
5263
5264 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
5265 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
5266 if (have_bnum)
5267 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
5268 bnum, astr1, astr2);
5269 else
5270 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
5271 }
5272
5273 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
5274 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
5275 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
5276 this function is simply the identity function. */
5277
5278 static CORE_ADDR
5279 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5280 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
5281 {
5282 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
5283 {
5284 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
5285 return bpaddr;
5286 }
5287 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
5288 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5289 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
5290 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
5291 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
5292 {
5293 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
5294 have their addresses modified. */
5295 return bpaddr;
5296 }
5297 else
5298 {
5299 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
5300
5301 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
5302 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
5303 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
5304
5305 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
5306 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
5307 is required. */
5308 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
5309 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
5310
5311 return adjusted_bpaddr;
5312 }
5313 }
5314
5315 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
5316
5317 static struct bp_location *
5318 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5319 {
5320 struct bp_location *loc;
5321
5322 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
5323 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
5324
5325 loc->owner = bpt;
5326 loc->cond = NULL;
5327 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
5328 loc->enabled = 1;
5329
5330 switch (bpt->type)
5331 {
5332 case bp_breakpoint:
5333 case bp_until:
5334 case bp_finish:
5335 case bp_longjmp:
5336 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5337 case bp_step_resume:
5338 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5339 case bp_call_dummy:
5340 case bp_std_terminate:
5341 case bp_shlib_event:
5342 case bp_thread_event:
5343 case bp_overlay_event:
5344 case bp_jit_event:
5345 case bp_longjmp_master:
5346 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5347 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
5348 break;
5349 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5350 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
5351 break;
5352 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5353 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5354 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5355 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
5356 break;
5357 case bp_watchpoint:
5358 case bp_catchpoint:
5359 case bp_tracepoint:
5360 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5361 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5362 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
5363 break;
5364 default:
5365 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
5366 }
5367
5368 return loc;
5369 }
5370
5371 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
5372 {
5373 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
5374 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
5375 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
5376 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
5377 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
5378 if we remove it here, then the later call to
5379 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
5380 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
5381 with commands won't work. */
5382
5383 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_bp_location_callback, loc);
5384
5385 if (loc->cond)
5386 xfree (loc->cond);
5387
5388 if (loc->function_name)
5389 xfree (loc->function_name);
5390
5391 xfree (loc);
5392 }
5393
5394 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
5395 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
5396 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
5397
5398 static struct breakpoint *
5399 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5400 enum bptype bptype)
5401 {
5402 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
5403
5404 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
5405 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
5406
5407 b->type = bptype;
5408 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
5409 b->language = current_language->la_language;
5410 b->input_radix = input_radix;
5411 b->thread = -1;
5412 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5413 b->next = 0;
5414 b->silent = 0;
5415 b->ignore_count = 0;
5416 b->commands = NULL;
5417 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5418 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5419 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5420 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5421 b->ops = NULL;
5422 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5423
5424 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
5425 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
5426 of increasing numbers. */
5427
5428 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5429 if (b1 == 0)
5430 breakpoint_chain = b;
5431 else
5432 {
5433 while (b1->next)
5434 b1 = b1->next;
5435 b1->next = b;
5436 }
5437 return b;
5438 }
5439
5440 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5441 static void
5442 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5443 {
5444 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
5445
5446 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5447 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5448 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
5449 {
5450 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5451 NULL, NULL);
5452 if (loc->function_name)
5453 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5454 }
5455 }
5456
5457 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5458 static struct gdbarch *
5459 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5460 {
5461 if (sal.section)
5462 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5463 if (sal.symtab)
5464 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5465
5466 return NULL;
5467 }
5468
5469 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5470 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5471 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5472 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5473 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5474 is also returned as the value of this function.
5475
5476 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5477 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5478 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5479 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5480 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5481 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5482 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5483
5484 struct breakpoint *
5485 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5486 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5487 {
5488 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
5489 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5490 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5491
5492 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5493 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5494 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5495
5496 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5497 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5498
5499 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5500 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5501 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5502 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5503 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5504 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5505 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
5506
5507 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5508 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5509 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5510 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5511 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5512
5513 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5514 breakpoint resetting. */
5515 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5516
5517 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5518 b->source_file = NULL;
5519 else
5520 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5521 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5522 b->line_number = sal.line;
5523
5524 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5525
5526 breakpoints_changed ();
5527
5528 return b;
5529 }
5530
5531
5532 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5533 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5534 void
5535 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5536 {
5537 struct bp_location *bl;
5538
5539 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5540
5541 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5542 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5543 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5544 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5545 but it's easy to implmement. */
5546 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5547 bl->inserted = 1;
5548 }
5549
5550 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5551 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
5552 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5553
5554 void
5555 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5556 {
5557 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5558
5559 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5560 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5561 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5562 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5563 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5564 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5565 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5566 {
5567 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5568
5569 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5570 clone->thread = thread;
5571 }
5572 }
5573
5574 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5575 void
5576 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5577 {
5578 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5579
5580 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5581 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5582 {
5583 if (b->thread == thread)
5584 delete_breakpoint (b);
5585 }
5586 }
5587
5588 void
5589 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5590 {
5591 struct breakpoint *b;
5592
5593 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5594 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5595 {
5596 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5597 update_global_location_list (1);
5598 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5599 }
5600 }
5601
5602 void
5603 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5604 {
5605 struct breakpoint *b;
5606
5607 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5608 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5609 {
5610 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5611 update_global_location_list (0);
5612 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5613 }
5614 }
5615
5616 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
5617 master breakpoint. */
5618 void
5619 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
5620 {
5621 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5622
5623 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5624 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5625 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
5626 {
5627 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5628 clone->type = bp_std_terminate;
5629 }
5630 }
5631
5632 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
5633 void
5634 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
5635 {
5636 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5637
5638 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5639 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
5640 delete_breakpoint (b);
5641 }
5642
5643 struct breakpoint *
5644 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5645 {
5646 struct breakpoint *b;
5647
5648 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5649
5650 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5651 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5652 b->addr_string
5653 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5654
5655 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5656
5657 return b;
5658 }
5659
5660 void
5661 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5662 {
5663 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5664
5665 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5666 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5667 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5668 delete_breakpoint (b);
5669 }
5670
5671 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5672 {
5673 char **arg_p;
5674 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5675 char ***addr_string_p;
5676 int *not_found_ptr;
5677 };
5678
5679 struct lang_and_radix
5680 {
5681 enum language lang;
5682 int radix;
5683 };
5684
5685 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5686
5687 struct breakpoint *
5688 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5689 {
5690 struct breakpoint *b;
5691
5692 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5693 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5694 return b;
5695 }
5696
5697 void
5698 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5699 {
5700 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5701
5702 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5703 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5704 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5705 delete_breakpoint (b);
5706 }
5707
5708 struct breakpoint *
5709 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5710 {
5711 struct breakpoint *b;
5712
5713 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5714 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5715 return b;
5716 }
5717
5718 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5719 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5720
5721 void
5722 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5723 {
5724 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5725
5726 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5727 {
5728 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
5729 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5730
5731 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5732 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5733 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5734 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5735 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5736 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5737 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
5738 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5739 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
5740 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5741 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5742 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5743 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5744 #else
5745 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5746 #endif
5747 )
5748 {
5749 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5750 }
5751 }
5752 }
5753
5754 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5755 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5756
5757 static void
5758 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5759 {
5760 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5761 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5762
5763 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5764 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5765 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5766 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5767 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5768 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5769 return;
5770
5771 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5772 {
5773 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
5774 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5775
5776 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5777 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5778 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5779 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5780 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
5781 || b->type == bp_jit_event
5782 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5783 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5784 {
5785 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5786 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5787 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5788 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5789 loc->inserted = 0;
5790 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5791 {
5792 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5793 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5794 solib->so_name);
5795 }
5796 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5797 }
5798 }
5799 }
5800
5801 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5802
5803 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5804
5805 static void
5806 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5807 {
5808 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5809 }
5810
5811 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5812
5813 static int
5814 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5815 {
5816 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5817 }
5818
5819 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5820 catchpoints. */
5821
5822 static int
5823 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5824 {
5825 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5826 }
5827
5828 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5829
5830 static enum print_stop_action
5831 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5832 {
5833 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5834 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5835 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5836 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5837 }
5838
5839 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5840
5841 static void
5842 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5843 {
5844 struct value_print_options opts;
5845
5846 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5847
5848 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5849 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5850 is relatively readable). */
5851 if (opts.addressprint)
5852 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5853 annotate_field (5);
5854 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5855 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5856 {
5857 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5858 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5859 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5860 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5861 }
5862 }
5863
5864 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5865 catchpoints. */
5866
5867 static void
5868 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5869 {
5870 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5871 }
5872
5873 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5874 catchpoints. */
5875
5876 static void
5877 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
5878 {
5879 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
5880 }
5881
5882 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5883
5884 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5885 {
5886 insert_catch_fork,
5887 remove_catch_fork,
5888 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5889 print_it_catch_fork,
5890 print_one_catch_fork,
5891 print_mention_catch_fork,
5892 print_recreate_catch_fork
5893 };
5894
5895 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5896
5897 static void
5898 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5899 {
5900 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5901 }
5902
5903 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5904
5905 static int
5906 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5907 {
5908 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5909 }
5910
5911 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5912 catchpoints. */
5913
5914 static int
5915 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5916 {
5917 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5918 }
5919
5920 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5921
5922 static enum print_stop_action
5923 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5924 {
5925 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5926 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5927 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5928 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5929 }
5930
5931 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5932
5933 static void
5934 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5935 {
5936 struct value_print_options opts;
5937
5938 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5939 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5940 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5941 is relatively readable). */
5942 if (opts.addressprint)
5943 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5944 annotate_field (5);
5945 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5946 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5947 {
5948 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5949 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5950 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5951 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5952 }
5953 }
5954
5955 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5956 catchpoints. */
5957
5958 static void
5959 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5960 {
5961 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5962 }
5963
5964 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5965 catchpoints. */
5966
5967 static void
5968 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
5969 {
5970 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
5971 }
5972
5973 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5974
5975 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5976 {
5977 insert_catch_vfork,
5978 remove_catch_vfork,
5979 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5980 print_it_catch_vfork,
5981 print_one_catch_vfork,
5982 print_mention_catch_vfork,
5983 print_recreate_catch_vfork
5984 };
5985
5986 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5987 catchpoints. */
5988
5989 static void
5990 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5991 {
5992 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5993
5994 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5995 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5996 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5997 else
5998 {
5999 int i, iter;
6000
6001 for (i = 0;
6002 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6003 i++)
6004 {
6005 int elem;
6006
6007 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
6008 {
6009 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
6010 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
6011 uintptr_t vec_addr;
6012 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
6013 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
6014 vec_addr_offset;
6015 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
6016 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
6017 }
6018 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
6019 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
6020 }
6021 }
6022
6023 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
6024 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
6025 inf->any_syscall_count,
6026 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
6027 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
6028 }
6029
6030 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6031 catchpoints. */
6032
6033 static int
6034 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6035 {
6036 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
6037
6038 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
6039 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6040 --inf->any_syscall_count;
6041 else
6042 {
6043 int i, iter;
6044
6045 for (i = 0;
6046 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6047 i++)
6048 {
6049 int elem;
6050 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
6051 /* Shouldn't happen. */
6052 continue;
6053 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
6054 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
6055 }
6056 }
6057
6058 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
6059 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
6060 inf->any_syscall_count,
6061 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
6062 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
6063 }
6064
6065 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6066 catchpoints. */
6067
6068 static int
6069 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6070 {
6071 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
6072 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
6073 syscall we are catching. */
6074 int syscall_number = 0;
6075
6076 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
6077 return 0;
6078
6079 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
6080 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6081 {
6082 int i, iter;
6083
6084 for (i = 0;
6085 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6086 i++)
6087 if (syscall_number == iter)
6088 break;
6089 /* Not the same. */
6090 if (!iter)
6091 return 0;
6092 }
6093
6094 return 1;
6095 }
6096
6097 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6098 catchpoints. */
6099
6100 static enum print_stop_action
6101 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6102 {
6103 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
6104 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
6105 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
6106 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
6107 ptid_t ptid;
6108 struct target_waitstatus last;
6109 struct syscall s;
6110 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6111 char *syscall_id;
6112
6113 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
6114
6115 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
6116
6117 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6118
6119 if (s.name == NULL)
6120 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
6121 else
6122 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
6123
6124 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
6125
6126 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
6127 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
6128 b->number, syscall_id);
6129 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
6130 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
6131 b->number, syscall_id);
6132
6133 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6134
6135 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6136 }
6137
6138 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6139 catchpoints. */
6140
6141 static void
6142 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
6143 struct bp_location **last_loc)
6144 {
6145 struct value_print_options opts;
6146
6147 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6148 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6149 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6150 is relatively readable). */
6151 if (opts.addressprint)
6152 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6153 annotate_field (5);
6154
6155 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
6156 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
6157 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
6158 else
6159 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
6160
6161 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6162 {
6163 int i, iter;
6164 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
6165
6166 for (i = 0;
6167 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6168 i++)
6169 {
6170 char *x = text;
6171 struct syscall s;
6172 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6173
6174 if (s.name != NULL)
6175 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
6176 else
6177 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
6178
6179 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
6180 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
6181 on every call. */
6182 xfree (x);
6183 }
6184 /* Remove the last comma. */
6185 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
6186 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
6187 }
6188 else
6189 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
6190 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6191 }
6192
6193 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6194 catchpoints. */
6195
6196 static void
6197 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6198 {
6199 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6200 {
6201 int i, iter;
6202
6203 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
6204 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
6205 else
6206 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
6207
6208 for (i = 0;
6209 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6210 i++)
6211 {
6212 struct syscall s;
6213 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6214
6215 if (s.name)
6216 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
6217 else
6218 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
6219 }
6220 printf_filtered (")");
6221 }
6222 else
6223 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
6224 b->number);
6225 }
6226
6227 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6228 catchpoints. */
6229
6230 static void
6231 print_recreate_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6232 {
6233 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch syscall");
6234
6235 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6236 {
6237 int i, iter;
6238
6239 for (i = 0;
6240 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6241 i++)
6242 {
6243 struct syscall s;
6244
6245 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6246 if (s.name)
6247 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", s.name);
6248 else
6249 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %d", s.number);
6250 }
6251 }
6252 }
6253
6254 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
6255
6256 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
6257 {
6258 insert_catch_syscall,
6259 remove_catch_syscall,
6260 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
6261 print_it_catch_syscall,
6262 print_one_catch_syscall,
6263 print_mention_catch_syscall,
6264 print_recreate_catch_syscall
6265 };
6266
6267 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
6268
6269 static int
6270 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6271 {
6272 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
6273 }
6274
6275 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
6276 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
6277 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
6278 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
6279
6280 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
6281 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
6282 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
6283 to the catchpoint. */
6284
6285 static struct breakpoint *
6286 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
6287 char *cond_string,
6288 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6289 {
6290 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6291 struct breakpoint *b;
6292
6293 init_sal (&sal);
6294 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
6295
6296 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
6297 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6298 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6299
6300 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
6301 b->thread = -1;
6302 b->addr_string = NULL;
6303 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6304 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6305 b->ops = ops;
6306
6307 return b;
6308 }
6309
6310 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
6311
6312 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
6313 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
6314 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
6315 to the catchpoint. */
6316
6317 static struct breakpoint *
6318 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
6319 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6320 {
6321 struct breakpoint *b =
6322 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6323
6324 mention (b);
6325 update_global_location_list (1);
6326
6327 return b;
6328 }
6329
6330 static void
6331 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6332 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
6333 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6334 {
6335 struct breakpoint *b
6336 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6337
6338 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
6339 area. */
6340 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
6341 }
6342
6343 /* Exec catchpoints. */
6344
6345 static void
6346 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6347 {
6348 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6349 }
6350
6351 static int
6352 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6353 {
6354 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6355 }
6356
6357 static int
6358 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6359 {
6360 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
6361 }
6362
6363 static enum print_stop_action
6364 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6365 {
6366 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6367 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
6368 b->exec_pathname);
6369 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6370 }
6371
6372 static void
6373 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6374 {
6375 struct value_print_options opts;
6376
6377 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6378
6379 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6380 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6381 is relatively readable). */
6382 if (opts.addressprint)
6383 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6384 annotate_field (5);
6385 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
6386 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
6387 {
6388 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
6389 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
6390 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6391 }
6392 }
6393
6394 static void
6395 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6396 {
6397 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
6398 }
6399
6400 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
6401 catchpoints. */
6402
6403 static void
6404 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6405 {
6406 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
6407 }
6408
6409 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
6410 {
6411 insert_catch_exec,
6412 remove_catch_exec,
6413 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
6414 print_it_catch_exec,
6415 print_one_catch_exec,
6416 print_mention_catch_exec,
6417 print_recreate_catch_exec
6418 };
6419
6420 static void
6421 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
6422 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6423 {
6424 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
6425 struct breakpoint *b =
6426 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
6427
6428 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
6429
6430 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
6431 location list. */
6432 mention (b);
6433 update_global_location_list (1);
6434 }
6435
6436 static int
6437 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
6438 {
6439 struct breakpoint *b;
6440 int i = 0;
6441
6442 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6443 {
6444 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6445 i++;
6446 }
6447
6448 return i;
6449 }
6450
6451 static int
6452 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
6453 {
6454 struct breakpoint *b;
6455 int i = 0;
6456
6457 *other_type_used = 0;
6458 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6459 {
6460 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
6461 {
6462 if (b->type == type)
6463 i++;
6464 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
6465 *other_type_used = 1;
6466 }
6467 }
6468 return i;
6469 }
6470
6471 void
6472 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
6473 {
6474 struct breakpoint *b;
6475
6476 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6477 {
6478 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6479 {
6480 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
6481 update_global_location_list (0);
6482 }
6483 }
6484 }
6485
6486 void
6487 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
6488 {
6489 struct breakpoint *b;
6490
6491 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6492 {
6493 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6494 {
6495 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6496 update_global_location_list (1);
6497 }
6498 }
6499 }
6500
6501 void
6502 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
6503 {
6504 struct breakpoint *b;
6505 int found = 0;
6506
6507 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6508 {
6509 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6510 continue;
6511
6512 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6513 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6514 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6515 {
6516 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6517 found = 1;
6518 }
6519 }
6520
6521 if (found)
6522 update_global_location_list (0);
6523
6524 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6525 }
6526
6527 void
6528 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6529 {
6530 struct breakpoint *b;
6531 int found = 0;
6532
6533 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6534
6535 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6536 {
6537 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6538 continue;
6539
6540 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6541 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6542 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6543 {
6544 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6545 found = 1;
6546 }
6547 }
6548
6549 if (found)
6550 breakpoint_re_set ();
6551 }
6552
6553
6554 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6555 at address specified by SAL.
6556 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6557
6558 struct breakpoint *
6559 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6560 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6561 {
6562 struct breakpoint *b;
6563
6564 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6565 one. */
6566 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6567
6568 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6569 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6570 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6571 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6572
6573 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
6574 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
6575 single thread of control. */
6576 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6577 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6578
6579 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6580
6581 return b;
6582 }
6583
6584 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6585 ORIG is NULL. */
6586
6587 struct breakpoint *
6588 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6589 {
6590 struct breakpoint *copy;
6591
6592 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6593 if (orig == NULL)
6594 return NULL;
6595
6596 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6597 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6598 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6599
6600 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6601 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6602 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6603 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6604 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6605
6606 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6607 copy->source_file = NULL;
6608 else
6609 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6610
6611 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6612 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6613 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6614 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6615
6616 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6617 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6618 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6619
6620 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6621 return copy;
6622 }
6623
6624 struct breakpoint *
6625 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6626 enum bptype type)
6627 {
6628 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6629
6630 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6631 sal.pc = pc;
6632 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6633 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6634
6635 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6636 }
6637 \f
6638
6639 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6640
6641 static void
6642 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6643 {
6644 int say_where = 0;
6645 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6646 struct value_print_options opts;
6647
6648 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6649
6650 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6651 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6652 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6653 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6654 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6655
6656 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6657 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6658 else
6659 switch (b->type)
6660 {
6661 case bp_none:
6662 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6663 break;
6664 case bp_watchpoint:
6665 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6666 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6667 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6668 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6669 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6670 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6671 break;
6672 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6673 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6674 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6675 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6676 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6677 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6678 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6679 break;
6680 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6681 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6682 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6683 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6684 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6685 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6686 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6687 break;
6688 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6689 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6690 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6691 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6692 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6693 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6694 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6695 break;
6696 case bp_breakpoint:
6697 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6698 {
6699 say_where = 0;
6700 break;
6701 }
6702 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6703 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6704 else
6705 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6706 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6707 say_where = 1;
6708 break;
6709 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6710 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6711 {
6712 say_where = 0;
6713 break;
6714 }
6715 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6716 say_where = 1;
6717 break;
6718 case bp_tracepoint:
6719 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6720 {
6721 say_where = 0;
6722 break;
6723 }
6724 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6725 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6726 say_where = 1;
6727 break;
6728 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6729 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6730 {
6731 say_where = 0;
6732 break;
6733 }
6734 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6735 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6736 say_where = 1;
6737 break;
6738 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6739 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6740 {
6741 say_where = 0;
6742 break;
6743 }
6744 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
6745 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6746 say_where = 1;
6747 break;
6748
6749 case bp_until:
6750 case bp_finish:
6751 case bp_longjmp:
6752 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6753 case bp_step_resume:
6754 case bp_call_dummy:
6755 case bp_std_terminate:
6756 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6757 case bp_shlib_event:
6758 case bp_thread_event:
6759 case bp_overlay_event:
6760 case bp_jit_event:
6761 case bp_longjmp_master:
6762 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6763 break;
6764 }
6765
6766 if (say_where)
6767 {
6768 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6769 single string. */
6770 if (b->loc == NULL)
6771 {
6772 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6773 }
6774 else
6775 {
6776 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6777 {
6778 printf_filtered (" at ");
6779 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6780 gdb_stdout);
6781 }
6782 if (b->source_file)
6783 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6784 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6785
6786 if (b->loc->next)
6787 {
6788 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6789 int n = 0;
6790 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6791 ++n;
6792 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6793 }
6794
6795 }
6796 }
6797 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6798 return;
6799 printf_filtered ("\n");
6800 }
6801 \f
6802
6803 static struct bp_location *
6804 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6805 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6806 {
6807 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6808
6809 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6810 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6811 ;
6812 *tmp = loc;
6813 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6814 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6815 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6816 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6817 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6818 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6819 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6820 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6821 loc->section = sal->section;
6822
6823 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6824 return loc;
6825 }
6826 \f
6827
6828 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6829 return 0 otherwise. */
6830
6831 static int
6832 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6833 {
6834 int len;
6835 CORE_ADDR addr;
6836 const gdb_byte *brk;
6837 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6838 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6839 int retval = 0;
6840
6841 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6842
6843 addr = loc->address;
6844 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6845
6846 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6847 if (brk == NULL)
6848 return 0;
6849
6850 target_mem = alloca (len);
6851
6852 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6853 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6854 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6855 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6856
6857 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6858 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6859
6860 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6861 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6862 retval = 1;
6863
6864 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6865
6866 return retval;
6867 }
6868
6869
6870
6871 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6872 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6873 as condition expression. */
6874
6875 static void
6876 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6877 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6878 char *cond_string,
6879 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6880 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6881 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6882 {
6883 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6884 int i;
6885
6886 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6887 {
6888 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6889 int target_resources_ok =
6890 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6891 i + 1, 0);
6892 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6893 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6894 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6895 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6896 }
6897
6898 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6899
6900 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6901 {
6902 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6903 struct bp_location *loc;
6904
6905 if (from_tty)
6906 {
6907 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6908 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6909 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6910
6911 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6912 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6913 }
6914
6915 if (i == 0)
6916 {
6917 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6918 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6919 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6920 b->thread = thread;
6921 b->task = task;
6922
6923 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6924 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6925 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6926 b->disposition = disposition;
6927 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6928
6929 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
6930 {
6931 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
6932
6933 if (is_marker_spec (addr_string))
6934 {
6935 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
6936 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
6937 char *p = &addr_string[3];
6938 char *endp;
6939 char *marker_str;
6940 int i;
6941
6942 while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
6943 p++;
6944
6945 endp = p;
6946 while (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
6947 endp++;
6948
6949 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
6950 b->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
6951
6952 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"),
6953 b->static_trace_marker_id);
6954 }
6955 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
6956 {
6957 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
6958 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
6959
6960 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"),
6961 b->static_trace_marker_id);
6962 }
6963 else
6964 warning (_("\
6965 Couldn't determine the static tracepoint marker to probe"));
6966 }
6967
6968 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6969 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6970 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6971 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6972
6973 loc = b->loc;
6974 }
6975 else
6976 {
6977 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6978 }
6979
6980 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6981 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6982
6983 if (b->cond_string)
6984 {
6985 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6986 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6987 if (*arg)
6988 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6989 }
6990 }
6991
6992 if (addr_string)
6993 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6994 else
6995 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6996 me. */
6997 b->addr_string
6998 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6999
7000 b->ops = ops;
7001 mention (b);
7002 }
7003
7004 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
7005 elements to fill the void space. */
7006 static void
7007 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
7008 {
7009 int i = index_to_remove+1;
7010 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
7011
7012 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
7013 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
7014
7015 --(sal->nelts);
7016 }
7017
7018 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
7019 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
7020 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
7021 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
7022 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
7023 single expanded sal, return the original.
7024
7025 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
7026 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
7027 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
7028 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
7029 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
7030
7031 static struct symtabs_and_lines
7032 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7033 {
7034 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
7035 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
7036 char *original_function = NULL;
7037 int found;
7038 int i;
7039 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7040
7041 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
7042 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
7043 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
7044 {
7045 expanded.nelts = 1;
7046 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7047 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7048 return expanded;
7049 }
7050
7051 sal.pc = 0;
7052
7053 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7054
7055 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
7056
7057 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
7058
7059 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
7060 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
7061
7062 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
7063 {
7064 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
7065 past the function prologue if necessary. */
7066 xfree (expanded.sals);
7067 expanded.nelts = 1;
7068 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7069 sal.pc = original_pc;
7070 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7071 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
7072 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7073 return expanded;
7074 }
7075
7076 if (!sal.explicit_line)
7077 {
7078 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
7079 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7080 {
7081 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
7082 char *this_function;
7083
7084 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
7085 read memory. */
7086 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
7087
7088 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
7089 &func_addr, &func_end))
7090 {
7091 if (this_function
7092 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
7093 {
7094 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
7095 --i;
7096 }
7097 }
7098 }
7099 }
7100
7101 /* Skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7102 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7103 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
7104
7105 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7106
7107 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
7108 {
7109 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
7110 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
7111 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
7112 xfree (expanded.sals);
7113 expanded.nelts = 1;
7114 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7115 sal.pc = original_pc;
7116 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7117 return expanded;
7118 }
7119
7120 if (original_pc)
7121 {
7122 found = 0;
7123 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7124 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
7125 {
7126 found = 1;
7127 break;
7128 }
7129 gdb_assert (found);
7130 }
7131
7132 return expanded;
7133 }
7134
7135 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
7136 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
7137 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
7138 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
7139 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
7140 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
7141 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
7142 we take just a single condition string.
7143
7144 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
7145 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
7146 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
7147 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
7148 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
7149
7150 static void
7151 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7152 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
7153 char *cond_string,
7154 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
7155 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
7156 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
7157 int enabled)
7158 {
7159 int i;
7160
7161 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7162 {
7163 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
7164 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
7165
7166 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
7167 cond_string, type, disposition,
7168 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
7169 }
7170 }
7171
7172 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
7173 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
7174 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
7175 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
7176
7177 static void
7178 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
7179 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
7180 char ***addr_string,
7181 int *not_found_ptr)
7182 {
7183 char *addr_start = *address;
7184
7185 *addr_string = NULL;
7186 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
7187 breakpoint. */
7188 if ((*address) == NULL
7189 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
7190 {
7191 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7192 {
7193 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7194
7195 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
7196 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
7197 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7198 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
7199 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
7200 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
7201 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
7202 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
7203
7204 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
7205 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
7206 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
7207 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
7208 */
7209 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
7210
7211 sals->sals[0] = sal;
7212 sals->nelts = 1;
7213 }
7214 else
7215 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
7216 }
7217 else
7218 {
7219 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
7220 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
7221 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
7222 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
7223 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
7224 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
7225
7226 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
7227
7228 if (default_breakpoint_valid
7229 && (!cursal.symtab
7230 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
7231 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
7232 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7233 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
7234 not_found_ptr);
7235 else
7236 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
7237 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
7238 }
7239 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
7240 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
7241 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
7242 if (addr_start != (*address))
7243 {
7244 int i;
7245
7246 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7247 {
7248 /* Add the string if not present. */
7249 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
7250 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start,
7251 (*address) - addr_start);
7252 }
7253 }
7254 }
7255
7256
7257 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
7258 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
7259
7260 static void
7261 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
7262 {
7263 int i;
7264
7265 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7266 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
7267 }
7268
7269 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
7270 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
7271 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
7272 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
7273 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
7274 it, etc. */
7275
7276 static void
7277 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7278 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
7279 {
7280 int i, rslt;
7281 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
7282 char *msg;
7283 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7284
7285 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7286 {
7287 sal = &sals->sals[i];
7288
7289 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
7290 NULL, &msg);
7291 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
7292
7293 if (!rslt)
7294 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
7295 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
7296
7297 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7298 }
7299 }
7300
7301 static void
7302 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
7303 {
7304 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
7305
7306 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
7307 args->not_found_ptr);
7308 }
7309
7310 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
7311 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
7312 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
7313 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
7314 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
7315 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
7316 static void
7317 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
7318 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
7319 {
7320 *cond_string = NULL;
7321 *thread = -1;
7322 while (tok && *tok)
7323 {
7324 char *end_tok;
7325 int toklen;
7326 char *cond_start = NULL;
7327 char *cond_end = NULL;
7328
7329 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7330 tok++;
7331
7332 end_tok = tok;
7333
7334 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7335 end_tok++;
7336
7337 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7338
7339 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7340 {
7341 struct expression *expr;
7342
7343 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7344 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
7345 xfree (expr);
7346 cond_end = tok;
7347 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
7348 cond_end - cond_start);
7349 }
7350 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7351 {
7352 char *tmptok;
7353
7354 tok = end_tok + 1;
7355 tmptok = tok;
7356 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7357 if (tok == tmptok)
7358 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
7359 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
7360 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
7361 }
7362 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
7363 {
7364 char *tmptok;
7365
7366 tok = end_tok + 1;
7367 tmptok = tok;
7368 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7369 if (tok == tmptok)
7370 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
7371 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
7372 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
7373 }
7374 else
7375 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7376 }
7377 }
7378
7379 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
7380
7381 static struct symtabs_and_lines
7382 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (char **arg_p)
7383 {
7384 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
7385 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7386 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7387 struct symbol *sym;
7388 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7389 char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
7390 char *endp;
7391 char *marker_str;
7392 int i;
7393
7394 while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
7395 p++;
7396
7397 endp = p;
7398 while (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7399 endp++;
7400
7401 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
7402 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
7403
7404 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
7405 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
7406 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
7407
7408 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
7409 sals.sals = xmalloc (sizeof *sals.sals * sals.nelts);
7410
7411 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7412 {
7413 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
7414
7415 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
7416
7417 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
7418
7419 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
7420 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
7421
7422 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
7423 }
7424
7425 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7426
7427 *arg_p = endp;
7428 return sals;
7429 }
7430
7431 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
7432 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
7433 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
7434 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
7435 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
7436 location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
7437 COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. Returns true if any breakpoint
7438 was created; false otherwise. */
7439
7440 int
7441 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7442 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
7443 int parse_condition_and_thread,
7444 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
7445 int ignore_count,
7446 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
7447 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7448 int from_tty,
7449 int enabled)
7450 {
7451 struct gdb_exception e;
7452 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7453 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
7454 char *copy_arg;
7455 char *addr_start = arg;
7456 char **addr_string;
7457 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7458 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
7459 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
7460 int i;
7461 int pending = 0;
7462 int not_found = 0;
7463 int task = 0;
7464 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
7465
7466 sals.sals = NULL;
7467 sals.nelts = 0;
7468 addr_string = NULL;
7469
7470 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
7471 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
7472 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
7473 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
7474
7475 if (type_wanted == bp_static_tracepoint && is_marker_spec (arg))
7476 {
7477 int i;
7478
7479 sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
7480
7481 copy_arg = savestring (addr_start, arg - addr_start);
7482 addr_string = xcalloc (sals.nelts, sizeof (char **));
7483 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7484 addr_string[i] = xstrdup (copy_arg);
7485 goto done;
7486 }
7487
7488 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
7489 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
7490
7491 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
7492 switch (e.reason)
7493 {
7494 case RETURN_QUIT:
7495 throw_exception (e);
7496 case RETURN_ERROR:
7497 switch (e.error)
7498 {
7499 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
7500
7501 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
7502 error. */
7503
7504 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
7505 throw_exception (e);
7506
7507 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
7508
7509 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
7510 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
7511 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
7512 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
7513 return 0;
7514
7515 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
7516 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
7517 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
7518 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
7519 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
7520 addr_string = &copy_arg;
7521 sals.nelts = 1;
7522 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
7523 pending_sal.pc = 0;
7524 pending = 1;
7525 break;
7526 default:
7527 throw_exception (e);
7528 }
7529 default:
7530 if (!sals.nelts)
7531 return 0;
7532 }
7533
7534 done:
7535
7536 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
7537 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7538
7539 if (!pending)
7540 {
7541 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
7542 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
7543
7544 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
7545 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
7546 }
7547
7548 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
7549 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
7550 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
7551 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
7552 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7553
7554 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
7555 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
7556 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7557 {
7558 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
7559 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
7560 }
7561
7562 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
7563 are ok for the target. */
7564 if (!pending)
7565 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals);
7566
7567 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
7568 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
7569 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
7570
7571 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
7572 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
7573 breakpoint. */
7574 if (!pending)
7575 {
7576 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
7577 {
7578 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
7579 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
7580 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
7581 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
7582 cond_string = NULL;
7583 thread = -1;
7584 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
7585 &thread, &task);
7586 if (cond_string)
7587 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7588 }
7589 else
7590 {
7591 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
7592 if (cond_string)
7593 {
7594 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
7595 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7596 }
7597 }
7598
7599 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
7600 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
7601 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
7602 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
7603 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
7604 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
7605 if (type_wanted == bp_static_tracepoint
7606 && is_marker_spec (addr_string[0]))
7607 {
7608 int i;
7609
7610 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7611 {
7612 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
7613 struct breakpoint *tp;
7614 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7615
7616 expanded.nelts = 1;
7617 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7618 expanded.sals[0] = sals.sals[i];
7619 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, expanded.sals);
7620
7621 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
7622 cond_string, type_wanted,
7623 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7624 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
7625 from_tty, enabled);
7626
7627 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7628
7629 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
7630 tp = get_breakpoint (breakpoint_count);
7631 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
7632
7633 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
7634 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
7635 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
7636 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
7637 try to match up which of the newly found markers
7638 corresponds to this one */
7639 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
7640 }
7641 }
7642 else
7643 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string,
7644 type_wanted, tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7645 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
7646 enabled);
7647 }
7648 else
7649 {
7650 struct breakpoint *b;
7651
7652 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7653
7654 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7655 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7656 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7657 b->thread = -1;
7658 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7659 b->cond_string = NULL;
7660 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7661 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7662 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7663 b->ops = ops;
7664 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7665 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7666
7667 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7668 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7669 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7670 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7671
7672 mention (b);
7673 }
7674
7675 if (sals.nelts > 1)
7676 {
7677 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
7678 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
7679 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
7680 }
7681
7682 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
7683 breakpoint. */
7684 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
7685 /* But cleanup everything else. */
7686 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7687
7688 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
7689 update_global_location_list (1);
7690
7691 return 1;
7692 }
7693
7694 /* Set a breakpoint.
7695 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
7696 condition, and thread.
7697 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
7698 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
7699 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
7700
7701 static void
7702 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
7703 {
7704 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
7705 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
7706 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
7707 : bp_breakpoint);
7708
7709 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
7710 arg,
7711 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
7712 tempflag, type_wanted,
7713 0 /* Ignore count */,
7714 pending_break_support,
7715 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
7716 from_tty,
7717 1 /* enabled */);
7718 }
7719
7720
7721 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7722
7723 void
7724 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7725 {
7726 CORE_ADDR pc;
7727
7728 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7729 {
7730 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7731 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7732 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7733 sal->pc = pc;
7734
7735 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7736 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7737 if (sal->explicit_line)
7738 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7739 }
7740
7741 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7742 {
7743 struct blockvector *bv;
7744 struct block *b;
7745 struct symbol *sym;
7746
7747 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7748 if (bv != NULL)
7749 {
7750 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7751 if (sym != NULL)
7752 {
7753 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7754 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7755 }
7756 else
7757 {
7758 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7759 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7760 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7761 source). */
7762
7763 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7764 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7765
7766 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7767
7768 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7769 if (msym)
7770 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7771
7772 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7773 }
7774 }
7775 }
7776 }
7777
7778 void
7779 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7780 {
7781 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7782 }
7783
7784 void
7785 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7786 {
7787 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7788 }
7789
7790 static void
7791 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7792 {
7793 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7794 }
7795
7796 static void
7797 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7798 {
7799 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7800 }
7801
7802 static void
7803 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7804 {
7805 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7806 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7807 stop at <line>\n"));
7808 }
7809
7810 static void
7811 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7812 {
7813 int badInput = 0;
7814
7815 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7816 badInput = 1;
7817 else if (*arg != '*')
7818 {
7819 char *argptr = arg;
7820 int hasColon = 0;
7821
7822 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7823 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7824 function/method name */
7825 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7826 {
7827 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7828 argptr++;
7829 }
7830
7831 if (hasColon)
7832 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7833 else
7834 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7835 }
7836
7837 if (badInput)
7838 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7839 else
7840 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7841 }
7842
7843 static void
7844 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7845 {
7846 int badInput = 0;
7847
7848 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7849 badInput = 1;
7850 else
7851 {
7852 char *argptr = arg;
7853 int hasColon = 0;
7854
7855 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7856 it is probably a line number. */
7857 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7858 {
7859 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7860 argptr++;
7861 }
7862
7863 if (hasColon)
7864 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7865 else
7866 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7867 }
7868
7869 if (badInput)
7870 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7871 else
7872 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7873 }
7874
7875 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero means EXP is
7876 variable. Also the constant detection may fail for some constant
7877 expressions and in such case still falsely return zero. */
7878 static int
7879 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
7880 {
7881 int i = exp->nelts;
7882
7883 while (i > 0)
7884 {
7885 int oplenp, argsp;
7886
7887 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
7888 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
7889 i -= oplenp;
7890
7891 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
7892 {
7893 case BINOP_ADD:
7894 case BINOP_SUB:
7895 case BINOP_MUL:
7896 case BINOP_DIV:
7897 case BINOP_REM:
7898 case BINOP_MOD:
7899 case BINOP_LSH:
7900 case BINOP_RSH:
7901 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
7902 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
7903 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
7904 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
7905 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
7906 case BINOP_EQUAL:
7907 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
7908 case BINOP_LESS:
7909 case BINOP_GTR:
7910 case BINOP_LEQ:
7911 case BINOP_GEQ:
7912 case BINOP_REPEAT:
7913 case BINOP_COMMA:
7914 case BINOP_EXP:
7915 case BINOP_MIN:
7916 case BINOP_MAX:
7917 case BINOP_INTDIV:
7918 case BINOP_CONCAT:
7919 case BINOP_IN:
7920 case BINOP_RANGE:
7921 case TERNOP_COND:
7922 case TERNOP_SLICE:
7923 case TERNOP_SLICE_COUNT:
7924
7925 case OP_LONG:
7926 case OP_DOUBLE:
7927 case OP_DECFLOAT:
7928 case OP_LAST:
7929 case OP_COMPLEX:
7930 case OP_STRING:
7931 case OP_BITSTRING:
7932 case OP_ARRAY:
7933 case OP_TYPE:
7934 case OP_NAME:
7935 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
7936
7937 case UNOP_NEG:
7938 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
7939 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
7940 case UNOP_ADDR:
7941 case UNOP_HIGH:
7942 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check their
7943 operands. If they are constant, then so is the result of
7944 that operation. For instance, if A and B are determined to be
7945 constants, then so is "A + B".
7946
7947 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the value
7948 of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when ADDR is. */
7949 break;
7950
7951 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
7952 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
7953 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
7954 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as constant
7955 even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return true in this
7956 case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
7957 We also have to check for function symbols because they are
7958 always constant. */
7959 {
7960 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
7961
7962 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
7963 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
7964 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
7965 return 0;
7966 break;
7967 }
7968
7969 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
7970 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
7971 then it is not a constant. */
7972 default:
7973 return 0;
7974 }
7975 }
7976
7977 return 1;
7978 }
7979
7980 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7981 hw_read: watch read,
7982 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7983 static void
7984 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7985 {
7986 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7987 struct expression *exp;
7988 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
7989 struct value *val, *mark;
7990 struct frame_info *frame;
7991 char *exp_start = NULL;
7992 char *exp_end = NULL;
7993 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7994 int toklen;
7995 char *cond_start = NULL;
7996 char *cond_end = NULL;
7997 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7998 enum bptype bp_type;
7999 int mem_cnt = 0;
8000 int thread = -1;
8001 int pc = 0;
8002
8003 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
8004 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
8005 {
8006 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
8007
8008 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
8009 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
8010
8011 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
8012 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
8013 be the thread identifier. */
8014 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
8015 tok--;
8016 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
8017 tok--;
8018
8019 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
8020 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
8021
8022 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
8023 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
8024 reach a "thread" token. */
8025 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
8026 tok--;
8027
8028 end_tok = tok;
8029
8030 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
8031 tok--;
8032
8033 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
8034 calculate the length of the token. */
8035 tok++;
8036 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8037
8038 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
8039 {
8040 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
8041 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
8042 only in a specific thread. */
8043 char *endp;
8044
8045 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
8046 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
8047
8048 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
8049 thread ID. */
8050 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
8051 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
8052
8053 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
8054 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
8055 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
8056
8057 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
8058 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
8059 evaluate_expression() function. */
8060 *tok = '\0';
8061 }
8062 }
8063
8064 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
8065 innermost_block = NULL;
8066 exp_start = arg;
8067 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
8068 exp_end = arg;
8069 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
8070 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
8071 prettier. */
8072 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
8073 --exp_end;
8074
8075 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
8076 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
8077 {
8078 int len;
8079
8080 len = exp_end - exp_start;
8081 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
8082 len--;
8083 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
8084 }
8085
8086 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
8087 mark = value_mark ();
8088 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, NULL, NULL);
8089 if (val != NULL)
8090 release_value (val);
8091
8092 tok = arg;
8093 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
8094 tok++;
8095 end_tok = tok;
8096
8097 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
8098 end_tok++;
8099
8100 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8101 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
8102 {
8103 struct expression *cond;
8104
8105 innermost_block = NULL;
8106 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
8107 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
8108
8109 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
8110 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
8111 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
8112
8113 xfree (cond);
8114 cond_end = tok;
8115 }
8116 if (*tok)
8117 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
8118
8119 if (accessflag == hw_read)
8120 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
8121 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
8122 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
8123 else
8124 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
8125
8126 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
8127 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8128 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
8129 if (mem_cnt != 0)
8130 {
8131 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
8132 target_resources_ok =
8133 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
8134 other_type_used);
8135 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8136 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
8137
8138 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8139 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
8140 }
8141
8142 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
8143 watchpoint could not be set. */
8144 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
8145 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
8146
8147 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
8148
8149 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
8150 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
8151 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
8152 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
8153 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
8154 {
8155 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
8156 {
8157 scope_breakpoint
8158 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
8159 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
8160 bp_watchpoint_scope);
8161
8162 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8163
8164 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
8165 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
8166
8167 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
8168 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
8169
8170 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
8171 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
8172 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
8173 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
8174 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
8175 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
8176 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
8177 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
8178 scope_breakpoint->type);
8179 }
8180 }
8181
8182 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
8183 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
8184 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
8185 b->number = breakpoint_count;
8186 b->thread = thread;
8187 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8188 b->exp = exp;
8189 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
8190 b->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
8191 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
8192 b->val = val;
8193 b->val_valid = 1;
8194 if (cond_start)
8195 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
8196 else
8197 b->cond_string = 0;
8198
8199 if (frame)
8200 {
8201 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
8202 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
8203 }
8204 else
8205 {
8206 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
8207 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
8208 }
8209
8210 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
8211 {
8212 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
8213 need to act on them together. */
8214 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
8215 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
8216 }
8217
8218 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8219
8220 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
8221 that should be inserted. */
8222 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
8223
8224 mention (b);
8225 update_global_location_list (1);
8226 }
8227
8228 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
8229 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
8230 in hardware return zero. */
8231
8232 static int
8233 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
8234 {
8235 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
8236 struct value *head = v;
8237
8238 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
8239 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
8240 return 0;
8241
8242 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
8243 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
8244 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
8245 hardware watchpoint.
8246
8247 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
8248 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
8249 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
8250 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
8251 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
8252 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
8253 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
8254 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
8255 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
8256
8257 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
8258 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
8259 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
8260 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
8261 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
8262 {
8263 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
8264 {
8265 if (value_lazy (v))
8266 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
8267 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
8268 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
8269 ;
8270 else
8271 {
8272 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
8273 it with hardware watchpoints. */
8274 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
8275
8276 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
8277 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
8278 middle of some value chain. */
8279 if (v == head
8280 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8281 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
8282 {
8283 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
8284 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
8285
8286 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
8287 return 0;
8288 else
8289 found_memory_cnt++;
8290 }
8291 }
8292 }
8293 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
8294 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
8295 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
8296 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
8297 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
8298 }
8299
8300 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
8301 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
8302 return found_memory_cnt;
8303 }
8304
8305 void
8306 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
8307 {
8308 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
8309 }
8310
8311 static void
8312 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8313 {
8314 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
8315 }
8316
8317 void
8318 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
8319 {
8320 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
8321 }
8322
8323 static void
8324 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8325 {
8326 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
8327 }
8328
8329 void
8330 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
8331 {
8332 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
8333 }
8334
8335 static void
8336 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8337 {
8338 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
8339 }
8340 \f
8341
8342 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
8343 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
8344
8345 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
8346 {
8347 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
8348 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
8349 };
8350
8351 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
8352 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
8353 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
8354 command. */
8355 static void
8356 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
8357 {
8358 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
8359
8360 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
8361 if (a->breakpoint2)
8362 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
8363 }
8364
8365 void
8366 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
8367 {
8368 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8369 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8370 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
8371 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
8372 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
8373 struct cleanup *old_chain;
8374
8375 clear_proceed_status ();
8376
8377 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
8378 this function */
8379
8380 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
8381 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
8382 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
8383 else
8384 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
8385 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
8386
8387 if (sals.nelts != 1)
8388 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
8389
8390 sal = sals.sals[0];
8391 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
8392
8393 if (*arg)
8394 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8395
8396 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
8397
8398 if (anywhere)
8399 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
8400 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
8401 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
8402 null_frame_id, bp_until);
8403 else
8404 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
8405 at the very same frame. */
8406 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
8407 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
8408 bp_until);
8409
8410 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
8411
8412 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
8413 one. */
8414
8415 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
8416 {
8417 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
8418 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
8419 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
8420 sal,
8421 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
8422 bp_until);
8423 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
8424 }
8425
8426 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
8427
8428 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
8429 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
8430 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
8431 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
8432
8433 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
8434 {
8435 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
8436 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
8437
8438 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
8439 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
8440
8441 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
8442 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
8443 until_break_command_continuation, args,
8444 xfree);
8445 }
8446 else
8447 do_cleanups (old_chain);
8448 }
8449
8450 static void
8451 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
8452 {
8453 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
8454 return;
8455 while (isspace (**s))
8456 *s += 1;
8457 }
8458
8459 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
8460 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
8461
8462 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
8463 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
8464 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
8465 if clause in the arg string. */
8466
8467 static char *
8468 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
8469 {
8470 char *cond_string;
8471
8472 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
8473 return NULL;
8474
8475 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
8476 (*arg) += 2;
8477
8478 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
8479 condition string. */
8480 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
8481 cond_string = *arg;
8482
8483 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
8484 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
8485
8486 return cond_string;
8487 }
8488
8489 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
8490 process start/exit, etc. */
8491
8492 typedef enum
8493 {
8494 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
8495 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
8496 }
8497 catch_fork_kind;
8498
8499 static void
8500 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8501 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8502 {
8503 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8504 char *cond_string = NULL;
8505 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
8506 int tempflag;
8507
8508 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
8509 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
8510 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
8511
8512 if (!arg)
8513 arg = "";
8514 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8515
8516 /* The allowed syntax is:
8517 catch [v]fork
8518 catch [v]fork if <cond>
8519
8520 First, check if there's an if clause. */
8521 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8522
8523 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8524 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8525
8526 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
8527 and enable reporting of such events. */
8528 switch (fork_kind)
8529 {
8530 case catch_fork_temporary:
8531 case catch_fork_permanent:
8532 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8533 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
8534 break;
8535 case catch_vfork_temporary:
8536 case catch_vfork_permanent:
8537 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8538 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
8539 break;
8540 default:
8541 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
8542 break;
8543 }
8544 }
8545
8546 static void
8547 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8548 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8549 {
8550 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8551 int tempflag;
8552 char *cond_string = NULL;
8553
8554 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8555
8556 if (!arg)
8557 arg = "";
8558 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8559
8560 /* The allowed syntax is:
8561 catch exec
8562 catch exec if <cond>
8563
8564 First, check if there's an if clause. */
8565 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8566
8567 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8568 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8569
8570 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
8571 and enable reporting of such events. */
8572 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8573 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
8574 }
8575
8576 static enum print_stop_action
8577 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8578 {
8579 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
8580
8581 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8582
8583 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8584 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
8585 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
8586 b->loc->address,
8587 b->number, 1);
8588 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8589 ui_out_text (uiout,
8590 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
8591 : "Catchpoint ");
8592 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8593 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8594 ui_out_text (uiout,
8595 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
8596 : " (exception caught), ");
8597 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8598 {
8599 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8600 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
8601 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8602 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8603 }
8604 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8605 }
8606
8607 static void
8608 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8609 struct bp_location **last_loc)
8610 {
8611 struct value_print_options opts;
8612
8613 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8614 if (opts.addressprint)
8615 {
8616 annotate_field (4);
8617 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
8618 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
8619 else
8620 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
8621 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
8622 }
8623 annotate_field (5);
8624 if (b->loc)
8625 *last_loc = b->loc;
8626 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
8627 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
8628 else
8629 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
8630 }
8631
8632 static void
8633 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8634 {
8635 int bp_temp;
8636 int bp_throw;
8637
8638 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8639 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8640 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
8641 : _("Catchpoint "));
8642 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8643 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
8644 : _(" (catch)"));
8645 }
8646
8647 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for throw and
8648 catch catchpoints. */
8649
8650 static void
8651 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8652 {
8653 int bp_temp;
8654 int bp_throw;
8655
8656 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8657 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8658 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_temp ? "tcatch " : "catch ");
8659 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_throw ? "throw" : "catch");
8660 }
8661
8662 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
8663 NULL, /* insert */
8664 NULL, /* remove */
8665 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
8666 print_exception_catchpoint,
8667 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
8668 print_mention_exception_catchpoint,
8669 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint
8670 };
8671
8672 static int
8673 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8674 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
8675 {
8676 char *trigger_func_name;
8677
8678 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8679 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
8680 else
8681 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
8682
8683 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
8684 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
8685 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
8686 tempflag, bp_breakpoint,
8687 0,
8688 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
8689 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
8690 1 /* enabled */);
8691
8692 return 1;
8693 }
8694
8695 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
8696
8697 static void
8698 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
8699 int tempflag, int from_tty)
8700 {
8701 char *cond_string = NULL;
8702
8703 if (!arg)
8704 arg = "";
8705 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8706
8707 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8708
8709 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8710 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8711
8712 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
8713 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8714 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
8715
8716 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
8717 return;
8718
8719 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
8720 }
8721
8722 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
8723
8724 static void
8725 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8726 {
8727 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8728
8729 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8730 }
8731
8732 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
8733
8734 static void
8735 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8736 {
8737 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8738
8739 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8740 }
8741
8742 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
8743
8744 static void
8745 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8746 struct symtab_and_line sal,
8747 char *addr_string,
8748 char *exp_string,
8749 char *cond_string,
8750 struct expression *cond,
8751 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8752 int tempflag,
8753 int from_tty)
8754 {
8755 struct breakpoint *b;
8756
8757 if (from_tty)
8758 {
8759 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8760 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8761 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8762
8763 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8764 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
8765 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
8766 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
8767 used for different exception names will use the same address.
8768 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
8769 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
8770 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
8771 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
8772 enough for now, though. */
8773 }
8774
8775 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
8776 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
8777
8778 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8779 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8780 b->number = breakpoint_count;
8781 b->ignore_count = 0;
8782 b->loc->cond = cond;
8783 b->addr_string = addr_string;
8784 b->language = language_ada;
8785 b->cond_string = cond_string;
8786 b->exp_string = exp_string;
8787 b->thread = -1;
8788 b->ops = ops;
8789
8790 mention (b);
8791 update_global_location_list (1);
8792 }
8793
8794 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
8795
8796 static void
8797 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
8798 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8799 {
8800 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8801 int tempflag;
8802 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8803 char *addr_string = NULL;
8804 char *exp_string = NULL;
8805 char *cond_string = NULL;
8806 struct expression *cond = NULL;
8807 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8808
8809 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8810
8811 if (!arg)
8812 arg = "";
8813 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
8814 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
8815 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
8816 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
8817 from_tty);
8818 }
8819
8820 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
8821 static void
8822 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
8823 {
8824 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
8825 VEC_free (int, iter);
8826 }
8827
8828 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
8829 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
8830 static VEC(int) *
8831 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
8832 {
8833 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
8834 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
8835
8836 while (*arg != '\0')
8837 {
8838 int i, syscall_number;
8839 char *endptr;
8840 char cur_name[128];
8841 struct syscall s;
8842
8843 /* Skip whitespace. */
8844 while (isspace (*arg))
8845 arg++;
8846
8847 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
8848 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
8849 cur_name[i] = '\0';
8850 arg += i;
8851
8852 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
8853 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
8854 if (*endptr == '\0')
8855 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
8856 else
8857 {
8858 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8859 to a number. */
8860 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8861
8862 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8863 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8864 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8865 be caught. */
8866 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8867 }
8868
8869 /* Ok, it's valid. */
8870 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8871 }
8872
8873 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8874 return result;
8875 }
8876
8877 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
8878
8879 static void
8880 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8881 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8882 {
8883 int tempflag;
8884 VEC(int) *filter;
8885 struct syscall s;
8886 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8887
8888 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8889 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8890 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8891 this architeture yet."));
8892
8893 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8894
8895 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8896
8897 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8898 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8899 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8900 for his/her architecture. */
8901 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8902
8903 /* The allowed syntax is:
8904 catch syscall
8905 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8906
8907 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8908
8909 if (arg != NULL)
8910 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8911 else
8912 filter = NULL;
8913
8914 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8915 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8916 }
8917
8918 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8919
8920 static void
8921 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8922 {
8923 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8924 int tempflag;
8925 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8926 char *addr_string = NULL;
8927 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8928
8929 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8930
8931 if (!arg)
8932 arg = "";
8933 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8934 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8935 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8936 }
8937
8938 static void
8939 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8940 {
8941 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8942 }
8943 \f
8944
8945 static void
8946 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8947 {
8948 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8949 }
8950
8951 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8952
8953 static void
8954 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8955 {
8956 struct breakpoint *b;
8957 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8958 int ix;
8959 int default_match;
8960 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8961 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8962 int i;
8963
8964 if (arg)
8965 {
8966 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8967 default_match = 0;
8968 }
8969 else
8970 {
8971 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8972 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8973 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8974 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8975 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8976 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8977 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8978 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8979 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8980 error (_("No source file specified."));
8981
8982 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8983 sals.nelts = 1;
8984
8985 default_match = 1;
8986 }
8987
8988 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8989 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8990 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8991 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8992 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8993
8994 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8995 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8996 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8997 due to optimization, all in one block.
8998 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8999 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
9000 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
9001 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
9002 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
9003 to support that. */
9004
9005 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
9006 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
9007 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
9008 one breakpoint. */
9009
9010 found = NULL;
9011 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9012 {
9013 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
9014 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
9015 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
9016 or at default pc.
9017
9018 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
9019
9020 0 1 pc
9021 1 1 pc _and_ line
9022 0 0 line
9023 1 0 <can't happen> */
9024
9025 sal = sals.sals[i];
9026
9027 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
9028 'found'. */
9029 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9030 {
9031 int match = 0;
9032 /* Are we going to delete b? */
9033 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
9034 {
9035 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
9036 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9037 {
9038 int pc_match = sal.pc
9039 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
9040 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
9041 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
9042 || loc->section == sal.section);
9043 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
9044 && b->source_file != NULL
9045 && sal.symtab != NULL
9046 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
9047 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
9048 && b->line_number == sal.line);
9049 if (pc_match || line_match)
9050 {
9051 match = 1;
9052 break;
9053 }
9054 }
9055 }
9056
9057 if (match)
9058 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
9059 }
9060 }
9061 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
9062 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
9063 {
9064 if (arg)
9065 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
9066 else
9067 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
9068 }
9069
9070 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
9071 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
9072 if (from_tty)
9073 {
9074 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
9075 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
9076 else
9077 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
9078 }
9079 breakpoints_changed ();
9080
9081 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
9082 {
9083 if (from_tty)
9084 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
9085 delete_breakpoint (b);
9086 }
9087 if (from_tty)
9088 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
9089 }
9090 \f
9091 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
9092 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
9093 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
9094
9095 void
9096 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
9097 {
9098 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9099
9100 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
9101 if (bs->breakpoint_at
9102 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
9103 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
9104 && bs->stop)
9105 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
9106
9107 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9108 {
9109 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
9110 delete_breakpoint (b);
9111 }
9112 }
9113
9114 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
9115 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
9116 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
9117 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
9118 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
9119
9120 static int
9121 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
9122 {
9123 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
9124 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
9125 /* A and B come from existing breakpoints having non-NULL OWNER. */
9126 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
9127 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
9128
9129 if (a->address != b->address)
9130 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
9131
9132 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
9133 if (a_perm != b_perm)
9134 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
9135
9136 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
9137 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
9138
9139 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
9140 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
9141 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
9142
9143 return (a > b) - (a < b);
9144 }
9145
9146 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
9147 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
9148 the bp_location array. */
9149
9150 static void
9151 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
9152 {
9153 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
9154
9155 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
9156 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
9157
9158 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
9159 {
9160 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
9161
9162 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
9163 continue;
9164
9165 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
9166 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
9167
9168 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
9169 addr = bl->address - start;
9170 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
9171 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
9172
9173 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
9174
9175 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
9176 addr = end - bl->address;
9177 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
9178 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
9179 }
9180 }
9181
9182 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
9183 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
9184 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
9185 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
9186 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
9187 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
9188 returns true on them.
9189
9190 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
9191 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
9192 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
9193 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
9194 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
9195 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
9196
9197 static void
9198 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
9199 {
9200 struct breakpoint *b;
9201 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
9202 struct cleanup *cleanups;
9203
9204 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
9205 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
9206 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
9207 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
9208 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
9209 once. */
9210 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
9211 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
9212 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
9213 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
9214
9215 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
9216 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
9217 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
9218 unsigned old_location_count;
9219
9220 old_location = bp_location;
9221 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
9222 bp_location = NULL;
9223 bp_location_count = 0;
9224 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
9225
9226 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9227 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
9228 bp_location_count++;
9229
9230 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
9231 locp = bp_location;
9232 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9233 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
9234 *locp++ = loc;
9235 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
9236 bp_location_compare);
9237
9238 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
9239
9240 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
9241 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
9242 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
9243 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
9244 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
9245
9246 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
9247 former bp_location array state respectively. */
9248
9249 locp = bp_location;
9250 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
9251 old_locp++)
9252 {
9253 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
9254 struct bp_location **loc2p;
9255
9256 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
9257 have to free it. */
9258 int found_object = 0;
9259 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
9260 int keep_in_target = 0;
9261 int removed = 0;
9262
9263 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
9264 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
9265 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
9266 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
9267 locp++;
9268
9269 for (loc2p = locp;
9270 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
9271 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
9272 loc2p++)
9273 {
9274 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
9275 {
9276 found_object = 1;
9277 break;
9278 }
9279 }
9280
9281 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
9282 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
9283 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
9284 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
9285 inserted. */
9286
9287 if (old_loc->inserted)
9288 {
9289 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
9290
9291 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
9292 {
9293 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
9294 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
9295 keep_in_target = 1;
9296 }
9297 else
9298 {
9299 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
9300 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
9301 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
9302
9303 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
9304 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
9305 {
9306 for (loc2p = locp;
9307 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
9308 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
9309 loc2p++)
9310 {
9311 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
9312
9313 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
9314 {
9315 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
9316 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
9317 loc2->duplicate = 0;
9318
9319 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
9320 access watchpoints, if the former are not
9321 supported, but the latter are. */
9322 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
9323 {
9324 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
9325 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
9326 }
9327
9328 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
9329 {
9330 loc2->inserted = 1;
9331 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
9332 keep_in_target = 1;
9333 break;
9334 }
9335 }
9336 }
9337 }
9338 }
9339
9340 if (!keep_in_target)
9341 {
9342 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
9343 {
9344 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
9345 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
9346 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
9347 succeed next time.
9348
9349 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
9350 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
9351 after calling us. */
9352 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
9353 old_loc->owner->number);
9354 }
9355 removed = 1;
9356 }
9357 }
9358
9359 if (!found_object)
9360 {
9361 if (removed && non_stop
9362 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
9363 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
9364 {
9365 /* This location was removed from the target. In
9366 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
9367 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
9368 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
9369 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
9370 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
9371 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
9372 after we see some number of events. The theory here
9373 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
9374 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
9375 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
9376 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
9377 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
9378 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
9379 SIGTRAP.
9380
9381 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
9382 decr_pc_after_break targets.
9383
9384 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
9385 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
9386 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
9387 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
9388 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
9389 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
9390 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
9391 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
9392 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
9393 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
9394 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
9395 targets that do not support new thread events, like
9396 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
9397 thread_count.
9398
9399 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
9400 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
9401 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
9402 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
9403
9404 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
9405 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
9406 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
9407 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
9408 traps we can no longer explain. */
9409
9410 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
9411 old_loc->owner = NULL;
9412
9413 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
9414 }
9415 else
9416 free_bp_location (old_loc);
9417 }
9418 }
9419
9420 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
9421 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
9422 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
9423 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
9424 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
9425 are sorted first for the same address.
9426
9427 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
9428 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
9429
9430 bp_loc_first = NULL;
9431 wp_loc_first = NULL;
9432 awp_loc_first = NULL;
9433 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
9434 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
9435 {
9436 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
9437 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
9438 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
9439
9440 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
9441 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
9442 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
9443 || !loc->enabled
9444 || loc->shlib_disabled
9445 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
9446 || is_tracepoint (b))
9447 continue;
9448
9449 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
9450 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
9451 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9452 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
9453 "actually inserted"));
9454
9455 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
9456 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
9457 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
9458 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
9459 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9460 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
9461 else
9462 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
9463
9464 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
9465 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
9466 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
9467 {
9468 *loc_first_p = loc;
9469 loc->duplicate = 0;
9470 continue;
9471 }
9472
9473 loc->duplicate = 1;
9474
9475 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
9476 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9477 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9478 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
9479 "a permanent breakpoint"));
9480 }
9481
9482 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
9483 && (have_live_inferiors ()
9484 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
9485 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
9486
9487 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9488 }
9489
9490 void
9491 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
9492 {
9493 struct bp_location *loc;
9494 int ix;
9495
9496 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
9497 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
9498 {
9499 free_bp_location (loc);
9500 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
9501 --ix;
9502 }
9503 }
9504
9505 static void
9506 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
9507 {
9508 struct gdb_exception e;
9509
9510 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9511 update_global_location_list (inserting);
9512 }
9513
9514 /* Clear LOC from a BPS. */
9515 static void
9516 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct bp_location *loc)
9517 {
9518 bpstat bs;
9519
9520 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
9521 if (bs->breakpoint_at == loc)
9522 {
9523 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
9524 bs->old_val = NULL;
9525 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
9526 }
9527 }
9528
9529 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
9530 static int
9531 bpstat_remove_bp_location_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
9532 {
9533 struct bp_location *loc = data;
9534
9535 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->stop_bpstat, loc);
9536 return 0;
9537 }
9538
9539 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
9540 structures. */
9541
9542 void
9543 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9544 {
9545 struct breakpoint *b;
9546
9547 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
9548
9549 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
9550 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
9551
9552 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
9553 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
9554 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
9555 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
9556 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
9557
9558 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
9559 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
9560 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
9561 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
9562 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
9563 return;
9564
9565 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
9566 breakpoints gets resolved. */
9567 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
9568 {
9569 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
9570 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
9571 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
9572 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
9573 }
9574
9575 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
9576
9577 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
9578 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
9579
9580 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9581 if (b->next == bpt)
9582 {
9583 b->next = bpt->next;
9584 break;
9585 }
9586
9587 decref_counted_command_line (&bpt->commands);
9588 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
9589 xfree (bpt->cond_exp);
9590 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
9591 xfree (bpt->exp);
9592 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
9593 value_free (bpt->val);
9594 xfree (bpt->source_file);
9595 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
9596 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
9597
9598 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
9599 list, update the global location list. This
9600 will remove locations that used to belong to
9601 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
9602 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
9603 looks at location's owner. It might be better
9604 design to have location completely self-contained,
9605 but it's not the case now. */
9606 update_global_location_list (0);
9607
9608
9609 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
9610 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
9611 bpt->type = bp_none;
9612
9613 xfree (bpt);
9614 }
9615
9616 static void
9617 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
9618 {
9619 delete_breakpoint (b);
9620 }
9621
9622 struct cleanup *
9623 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9624 {
9625 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
9626 }
9627
9628 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
9629 delete_breakpoint. */
9630
9631 static void
9632 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
9633 {
9634 delete_breakpoint (b);
9635 }
9636
9637 void
9638 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9639 {
9640 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9641
9642 dont_repeat ();
9643
9644 if (arg == 0)
9645 {
9646 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9647
9648 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9649 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9650 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9651 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9652 {
9653 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9654 && b->type != bp_std_terminate
9655 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9656 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9657 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9658 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9659 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9660 && b->type != bp_std_terminate_master
9661 && b->number >= 0)
9662 {
9663 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9664 break;
9665 }
9666 }
9667
9668 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9669 if (!from_tty
9670 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
9671 {
9672 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9673 {
9674 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9675 && b->type != bp_std_terminate
9676 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9677 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9678 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9679 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9680 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9681 && b->type != bp_std_terminate_master
9682 && b->number >= 0)
9683 delete_breakpoint (b);
9684 }
9685 }
9686 }
9687 else
9688 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
9689 }
9690
9691 static int
9692 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
9693 {
9694 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9695 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
9696 return 0;
9697 return 1;
9698 }
9699
9700 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
9701 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
9702 Null names are ignored. */
9703
9704 static int
9705 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
9706 {
9707 struct bp_location *l;
9708 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
9709 (int (*) (const void *,
9710 const void *)) streq,
9711 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
9712
9713 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
9714 {
9715 const char **slot;
9716 const char *name = l->function_name;
9717
9718 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
9719 if (name == NULL)
9720 continue;
9721
9722 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
9723 INSERT);
9724 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
9725 NULL. */
9726 if (*slot != NULL)
9727 {
9728 htab_delete (htab);
9729 return 1;
9730 }
9731 *slot = name;
9732 }
9733
9734 htab_delete (htab);
9735 return 0;
9736 }
9737
9738 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
9739 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
9740 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
9741 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
9742 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
9743 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
9744 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
9745 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
9746 The heuristic is:
9747
9748 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
9749 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
9750 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
9751 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
9752 in the sources, and output a warning.
9753
9754 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
9755 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
9756 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
9757 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
9758 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
9759 warning.
9760
9761 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
9762 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
9763 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
9764 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
9765 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
9766 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
9767 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
9768 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
9769 precisely because it confuses tools). */
9770
9771 static struct symtab_and_line
9772 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
9773 {
9774 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9775 CORE_ADDR pc;
9776 int i;
9777
9778 pc = sal.pc;
9779 if (sal.line)
9780 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
9781
9782 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
9783 {
9784 if (strcmp (b->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
9785 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
9786 b->number,
9787 b->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
9788
9789 xfree (b->static_trace_marker_id);
9790 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9791 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9792
9793 return sal;
9794 }
9795
9796 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
9797 by string ID. */
9798 if (!sal.explicit_pc
9799 && sal.line != 0
9800 && sal.symtab != NULL
9801 && b->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
9802 {
9803 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
9804
9805 markers
9806 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (b->static_trace_marker_id);
9807
9808 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9809 {
9810 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9811 struct symbol *sym;
9812 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9813
9814 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
9815
9816 xfree (b->static_trace_marker_id);
9817 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker->str_id);
9818
9819 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
9820 "found at previous line number"),
9821 b->number, b->static_trace_marker_id);
9822
9823 init_sal (&sal);
9824
9825 sal.pc = marker->address;
9826
9827 sal = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9828 sym = find_pc_sect_function (marker->address, NULL);
9829 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
9830 if (sym)
9831 {
9832 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
9833 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
9834 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
9835 }
9836 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", sal.symtab->filename);
9837 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
9838
9839 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
9840 {
9841 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
9842
9843 if (fullname)
9844 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
9845 }
9846
9847 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal.line);
9848 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
9849
9850 b->line_number = sal.line;
9851
9852 xfree (b->source_file);
9853 if (sym)
9854 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
9855 else
9856 b->source_file = NULL;
9857
9858 xfree (b->addr_string);
9859 b->addr_string = xstrprintf ("%s:%d",
9860 sal.symtab->filename, b->line_number);
9861
9862 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
9863 so. */
9864
9865 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9866 }
9867 }
9868 return sal;
9869 }
9870
9871 static void
9872 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
9873 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
9874 {
9875 int i;
9876 char *s;
9877 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
9878
9879 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
9880 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
9881 the common case where all locations are in the same
9882 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
9883 retain the location, so that when the library
9884 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
9885 status of the individual locations. */
9886 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
9887 return;
9888
9889 b->loc = NULL;
9890
9891 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9892 {
9893 struct bp_location *new_loc =
9894 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
9895
9896 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
9897 old symtab. */
9898 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
9899 {
9900 struct gdb_exception e;
9901
9902 s = b->cond_string;
9903 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9904 {
9905 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
9906 0);
9907 }
9908 if (e.reason < 0)
9909 {
9910 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
9911 b->number, e.message);
9912 new_loc->enabled = 0;
9913 }
9914 }
9915
9916 if (b->source_file != NULL)
9917 xfree (b->source_file);
9918 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
9919 b->source_file = NULL;
9920 else
9921 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
9922
9923 if (b->line_number == 0)
9924 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
9925 }
9926
9927 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
9928 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9929 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
9930
9931 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
9932 {
9933 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
9934 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
9935 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
9936 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
9937 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
9938 often enough until a better solution is found. */
9939 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
9940
9941 for (; e; e = e->next)
9942 {
9943 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
9944 {
9945 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
9946 if (have_ambiguous_names)
9947 {
9948 for (; l; l = l->next)
9949 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
9950 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
9951 {
9952 l->enabled = 0;
9953 break;
9954 }
9955 }
9956 else
9957 {
9958 for (; l; l = l->next)
9959 if (l->function_name
9960 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
9961 {
9962 l->enabled = 0;
9963 break;
9964 }
9965 }
9966 }
9967 }
9968 }
9969
9970 update_global_location_list (1);
9971 }
9972
9973 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
9974 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
9975 Unused in this case. */
9976
9977 static int
9978 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
9979 {
9980 /* get past catch_errs */
9981 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
9982 int not_found = 0;
9983 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
9984 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
9985 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
9986 char *s;
9987 struct gdb_exception e;
9988 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
9989 int marker_spec = 0;
9990
9991 switch (b->type)
9992 {
9993 case bp_none:
9994 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9995 b->number);
9996 return 0;
9997 case bp_breakpoint:
9998 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9999 case bp_tracepoint:
10000 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10001 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10002 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
10003 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
10004 return 0;
10005
10006 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
10007 {
10008 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
10009 delete_breakpoint (b);
10010 return 0;
10011 }
10012
10013 set_language (b->language);
10014 input_radix = b->input_radix;
10015 s = b->addr_string;
10016
10017 save_current_space_and_thread ();
10018 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
10019
10020 marker_spec = b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && is_marker_spec (s);
10021
10022 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10023 {
10024 if (marker_spec)
10025 {
10026 sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
10027 if (sals.nelts > b->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
10028 {
10029 sals.sals[0] = sals.sals[b->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
10030 sals.nelts = 1;
10031 }
10032 else
10033 error (_("marker %s not found"), b->static_trace_marker_id);
10034 }
10035 else
10036 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
10037 not_found_ptr);
10038 }
10039 if (e.reason < 0)
10040 {
10041 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
10042 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
10043 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
10044 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
10045 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
10046 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
10047 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
10048 if (not_found
10049 && (b->condition_not_parsed
10050 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
10051 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
10052 not_found_and_ok = 1;
10053
10054 if (!not_found_and_ok)
10055 {
10056 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
10057 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
10058 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
10059 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
10060 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
10061 which approach is better. */
10062 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
10063 throw_exception (e);
10064 }
10065 }
10066
10067 if (!not_found)
10068 {
10069 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
10070
10071 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
10072 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
10073 {
10074 char *cond_string = 0;
10075 int thread = -1;
10076 int task = 0;
10077
10078 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
10079 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
10080 if (cond_string)
10081 b->cond_string = cond_string;
10082 b->thread = thread;
10083 b->task = task;
10084 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
10085 }
10086
10087 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !marker_spec)
10088 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
10089
10090 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
10091 }
10092
10093 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
10094 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
10095 break;
10096
10097 case bp_watchpoint:
10098 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10099 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10100 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10101 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
10102 or it can be on local variables.
10103
10104 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
10105 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
10106 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
10107 and unloaded.
10108
10109 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10110 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
10111 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
10112 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
10113 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
10114 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10115
10116 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10117 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
10118 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10119 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10120
10121 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10122 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10123
10124 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
10125 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
10126 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
10127 break;
10128 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
10129 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
10130 loaded. */
10131 case bp_catchpoint:
10132 break;
10133
10134 default:
10135 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
10136 /* fall through */
10137 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
10138 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
10139 case bp_overlay_event:
10140 case bp_longjmp_master:
10141 case bp_std_terminate_master:
10142 delete_breakpoint (b);
10143 break;
10144
10145 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
10146 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
10147 case bp_shlib_event:
10148
10149 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
10150 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
10151 case bp_thread_event:
10152
10153 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
10154 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
10155 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
10156 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
10157 case bp_until:
10158 case bp_finish:
10159 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
10160 case bp_call_dummy:
10161 case bp_std_terminate:
10162 case bp_step_resume:
10163 case bp_longjmp:
10164 case bp_longjmp_resume:
10165 case bp_jit_event:
10166 break;
10167 }
10168
10169 do_cleanups (cleanups);
10170 return 0;
10171 }
10172
10173 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
10174 void
10175 breakpoint_re_set (void)
10176 {
10177 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
10178 enum language save_language;
10179 int save_input_radix;
10180 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10181
10182 save_language = current_language->la_language;
10183 save_input_radix = input_radix;
10184 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
10185
10186 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
10187 {
10188 /* Format possible error msg */
10189 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
10190 b->number);
10191 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
10192 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
10193 do_cleanups (cleanups);
10194 }
10195 set_language (save_language);
10196 input_radix = save_input_radix;
10197
10198 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
10199
10200 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10201
10202 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
10203 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
10204 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
10205 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
10206 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
10207 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ("std::terminate()");
10208 }
10209 \f
10210 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
10211
10212 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
10213 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
10214 void
10215 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
10216 {
10217 if (b->thread != -1)
10218 {
10219 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
10220 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
10221
10222 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
10223 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
10224 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
10225 as well. */
10226 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
10227 }
10228 }
10229
10230 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
10231 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
10232 which ends with a period (no newline). */
10233
10234 void
10235 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
10236 {
10237 struct breakpoint *b;
10238
10239 if (count < 0)
10240 count = 0;
10241
10242 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10243 if (b->number == bptnum)
10244 {
10245 if (is_tracepoint (b))
10246 {
10247 if (from_tty && count != 0)
10248 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
10249 bptnum);
10250 return;
10251 }
10252
10253 b->ignore_count = count;
10254 if (from_tty)
10255 {
10256 if (count == 0)
10257 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
10258 bptnum);
10259 else if (count == 1)
10260 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
10261 bptnum);
10262 else
10263 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
10264 count, bptnum);
10265 }
10266 breakpoints_changed ();
10267 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
10268 return;
10269 }
10270
10271 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
10272 }
10273
10274 void
10275 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
10276 {
10277 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
10278 b->silent = 1;
10279 }
10280
10281 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
10282
10283 static void
10284 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10285 {
10286 char *p = args;
10287 int num;
10288
10289 if (p == 0)
10290 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
10291
10292 num = get_number (&p);
10293 if (num == 0)
10294 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
10295 if (*p == 0)
10296 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
10297
10298 set_ignore_count (num,
10299 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
10300 from_tty);
10301 if (from_tty)
10302 printf_filtered ("\n");
10303 }
10304 \f
10305 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
10306 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
10307
10308 static void
10309 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
10310 void *),
10311 void *data)
10312 {
10313 char *p = args;
10314 char *p1;
10315 int num;
10316 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
10317 int match;
10318
10319 if (p == 0)
10320 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
10321
10322 while (*p)
10323 {
10324 match = 0;
10325 p1 = p;
10326
10327 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
10328 if (num == 0)
10329 {
10330 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
10331 }
10332 else
10333 {
10334 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
10335 if (b->number == num)
10336 {
10337 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
10338 match = 1;
10339 function (b, data);
10340 if (related_breakpoint)
10341 function (related_breakpoint, data);
10342 break;
10343 }
10344 if (match == 0)
10345 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
10346 }
10347 p = p1;
10348 }
10349 }
10350
10351 static struct bp_location *
10352 find_location_by_number (char *number)
10353 {
10354 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
10355 char *p1;
10356 int bp_num;
10357 int loc_num;
10358 struct breakpoint *b;
10359 struct bp_location *loc;
10360
10361 *dot = '\0';
10362
10363 p1 = number;
10364 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
10365 if (bp_num == 0)
10366 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
10367
10368 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10369 if (b->number == bp_num)
10370 {
10371 break;
10372 }
10373
10374 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
10375 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
10376
10377 p1 = dot+1;
10378 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
10379 if (loc_num == 0)
10380 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
10381
10382 --loc_num;
10383 loc = b->loc;
10384 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
10385 ;
10386 if (!loc)
10387 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
10388
10389 return loc;
10390 }
10391
10392
10393 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
10394 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
10395 which ends with a period (no newline). */
10396
10397 void
10398 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
10399 {
10400 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
10401 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
10402 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
10403 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
10404 return;
10405
10406 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
10407 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
10408 return;
10409
10410 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
10411
10412 update_global_location_list (0);
10413
10414 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
10415 }
10416
10417 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
10418 disable_breakpoint. */
10419
10420 static void
10421 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
10422 {
10423 disable_breakpoint (b);
10424 }
10425
10426 static void
10427 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10428 {
10429 struct breakpoint *bpt;
10430
10431 if (args == 0)
10432 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
10433 switch (bpt->type)
10434 {
10435 case bp_none:
10436 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10437 bpt->number);
10438 continue;
10439 case bp_breakpoint:
10440 case bp_tracepoint:
10441 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10442 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10443 case bp_catchpoint:
10444 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10445 case bp_watchpoint:
10446 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10447 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10448 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10449 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
10450 default:
10451 continue;
10452 }
10453 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
10454 {
10455 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
10456 if (loc)
10457 loc->enabled = 0;
10458 update_global_location_list (0);
10459 }
10460 else
10461 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
10462 }
10463
10464 static void
10465 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
10466 {
10467 int target_resources_ok;
10468
10469 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
10470 {
10471 int i;
10472 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10473 target_resources_ok =
10474 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10475 i + 1, 0);
10476 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
10477 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
10478 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
10479 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10480 }
10481
10482 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
10483 {
10484 struct gdb_exception e;
10485
10486 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
10487 {
10488 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
10489 }
10490 if (e.reason < 0)
10491 {
10492 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
10493 bpt->number);
10494 return;
10495 }
10496 }
10497
10498 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
10499 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10500 bpt->disposition = disposition;
10501 update_global_location_list (1);
10502 breakpoints_changed ();
10503
10504 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
10505 }
10506
10507
10508 void
10509 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
10510 {
10511 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
10512 }
10513
10514 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
10515 enable_breakpoint. */
10516
10517 static void
10518 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
10519 {
10520 enable_breakpoint (b);
10521 }
10522
10523 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
10524 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
10525 in stopping the inferior. */
10526
10527 static void
10528 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10529 {
10530 struct breakpoint *bpt;
10531
10532 if (args == 0)
10533 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
10534 switch (bpt->type)
10535 {
10536 case bp_none:
10537 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10538 bpt->number);
10539 continue;
10540 case bp_breakpoint:
10541 case bp_tracepoint:
10542 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10543 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10544 case bp_catchpoint:
10545 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10546 case bp_watchpoint:
10547 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10548 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10549 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10550 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
10551 default:
10552 continue;
10553 }
10554 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
10555 {
10556 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
10557 if (loc)
10558 loc->enabled = 1;
10559 update_global_location_list (1);
10560 }
10561 else
10562 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
10563 }
10564
10565 static void
10566 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
10567 {
10568 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
10569 }
10570
10571 static void
10572 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10573 {
10574 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
10575 }
10576
10577 static void
10578 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
10579 {
10580 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
10581 }
10582
10583 static void
10584 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10585 {
10586 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
10587 }
10588 \f
10589 static void
10590 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
10591 {
10592 }
10593
10594 static void
10595 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
10596 {
10597 }
10598
10599 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
10600 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
10601 GDB itself. */
10602
10603 static void
10604 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
10605 const bfd_byte *data)
10606 {
10607 struct breakpoint *bp;
10608
10609 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
10610 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
10611 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
10612 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
10613 {
10614 struct bp_location *loc;
10615
10616 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
10617 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
10618 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
10619 && addr + len > loc->address)
10620 {
10621 value_free (bp->val);
10622 bp->val = NULL;
10623 bp->val_valid = 0;
10624 }
10625 }
10626 }
10627
10628 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
10629
10630 struct symtabs_and_lines
10631 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
10632 {
10633 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
10634
10635 if (string == 0)
10636 error (_("Empty line specification."));
10637 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
10638 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
10639 default_breakpoint_symtab,
10640 default_breakpoint_line,
10641 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
10642 else
10643 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
10644 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
10645 if (*string)
10646 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
10647 return sals;
10648 }
10649
10650 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
10651 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
10652 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
10653 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
10654 someday. */
10655
10656 void *
10657 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
10658 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
10659 {
10660 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
10661
10662 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
10663
10664 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
10665 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
10666
10667 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
10668 {
10669 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
10670 xfree (bp_tgt);
10671 return NULL;
10672 }
10673
10674 return bp_tgt;
10675 }
10676
10677 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
10678
10679 int
10680 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
10681 {
10682 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
10683 int ret;
10684
10685 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
10686 xfree (bp_tgt);
10687
10688 return ret;
10689 }
10690
10691 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
10692
10693 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
10694 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
10695
10696 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
10697
10698 void
10699 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
10700 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
10701 {
10702 void **bpt_p;
10703
10704 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
10705 {
10706 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
10707 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
10708 }
10709 else
10710 {
10711 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
10712 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
10713 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
10714 }
10715
10716 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
10717 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
10718 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
10719 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
10720 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
10721 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
10722
10723 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
10724 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
10725 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
10726 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
10727 }
10728
10729 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
10730
10731 void
10732 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
10733 {
10734 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
10735
10736 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
10737 call. */
10738 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
10739 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
10740 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
10741 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
10742
10743 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
10744 {
10745 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
10746 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
10747 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
10748 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
10749 }
10750 }
10751
10752 /* Delete software single step breakpoints without removing them from
10753 the inferior. This is intended to be used if the inferior's address
10754 space where they were inserted is already gone, e.g. after exit or
10755 exec. */
10756
10757 void
10758 cancel_single_step_breakpoints (void)
10759 {
10760 int i;
10761
10762 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
10763 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
10764 {
10765 xfree (single_step_breakpoints[i]);
10766 single_step_breakpoints[i] = NULL;
10767 single_step_gdbarch[i] = NULL;
10768 }
10769 }
10770
10771 /* Detach software single-step breakpoints from INFERIOR_PTID without
10772 removing them. */
10773
10774 static void
10775 detach_single_step_breakpoints (void)
10776 {
10777 int i;
10778
10779 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
10780 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
10781 target_remove_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[i],
10782 single_step_breakpoints[i]);
10783 }
10784
10785 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
10786
10787 static int
10788 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
10789 CORE_ADDR pc)
10790 {
10791 int i;
10792
10793 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
10794 {
10795 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
10796 if (bp_tgt
10797 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
10798 bp_tgt->placed_address,
10799 aspace, pc))
10800 return 1;
10801 }
10802
10803 return 0;
10804 }
10805
10806 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
10807 non-zero otherwise. */
10808 static int
10809 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
10810 {
10811 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
10812 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
10813 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
10814 return 1;
10815 else
10816 return 0;
10817 }
10818
10819 int
10820 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
10821 {
10822 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
10823
10824 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
10825 }
10826
10827 int
10828 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
10829 {
10830 struct breakpoint *bp;
10831
10832 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
10833 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
10834 {
10835 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
10836 {
10837 int i, iter;
10838 for (i = 0;
10839 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
10840 i++)
10841 if (syscall_number == iter)
10842 return 1;
10843 }
10844 else
10845 return 1;
10846 }
10847
10848 return 0;
10849 }
10850
10851 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
10852 static char **
10853 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10854 char *text, char *word)
10855 {
10856 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
10857
10858 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
10859 }
10860
10861 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
10862
10863 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
10864 static void
10865 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
10866 {
10867 tracepoint_count = num;
10868 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
10869 }
10870
10871 void
10872 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10873 {
10874 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10875 arg,
10876 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10877 0 /* tempflag */,
10878 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
10879 0 /* Ignore count */,
10880 pending_break_support,
10881 NULL,
10882 from_tty,
10883 1 /* enabled */))
10884 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10885 }
10886
10887 void
10888 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10889 {
10890 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10891 arg,
10892 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10893 0 /* tempflag */,
10894 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
10895 0 /* Ignore count */,
10896 pending_break_support,
10897 NULL,
10898 from_tty,
10899 1 /* enabled */))
10900 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10901 }
10902
10903 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
10904
10905 void
10906 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10907 {
10908 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10909 arg,
10910 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10911 0 /* tempflag */,
10912 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
10913 0 /* Ignore count */,
10914 pending_break_support,
10915 NULL,
10916 from_tty,
10917 1 /* enabled */))
10918 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10919 }
10920
10921 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
10922 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
10923
10924 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
10925 static int next_cmd;
10926
10927 static char *
10928 read_uploaded_action (void)
10929 {
10930 char *rslt;
10931
10932 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
10933
10934 next_cmd++;
10935
10936 return rslt;
10937 }
10938
10939 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
10940 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
10941 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
10942 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
10943 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
10944
10945 struct breakpoint *
10946 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
10947 {
10948 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
10949 struct breakpoint *tp;
10950
10951 if (utp->at_string)
10952 addr_str = utp->at_string;
10953 else
10954 {
10955 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
10956 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
10957 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
10958 user. */
10959 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no source location, using raw address"),
10960 utp->number);
10961 sprintf (small_buf, "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
10962 addr_str = small_buf;
10963 }
10964
10965 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
10966 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
10967 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition has no source form, ignoring it"),
10968 utp->number);
10969
10970 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10971 addr_str,
10972 utp->cond_string, -1, 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
10973 0 /* tempflag */,
10974 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
10975 0 /* Ignore count */,
10976 pending_break_support,
10977 NULL,
10978 0 /* from_tty */,
10979 utp->enabled /* enabled */))
10980 return NULL;
10981
10982 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10983
10984 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
10985 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
10986 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
10987
10988 if (utp->pass > 0)
10989 {
10990 sprintf (small_buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
10991
10992 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
10993 }
10994
10995 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
10996 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
10997 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
10998 function. */
10999 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
11000 {
11001 struct command_line *cmd_list;
11002
11003 this_utp = utp;
11004 next_cmd = 0;
11005
11006 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
11007
11008 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, cmd_list);
11009 }
11010 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
11011 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
11012 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions have no source form, ignoring them"),
11013 utp->number);
11014
11015 return tp;
11016 }
11017
11018 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
11019 omitted. */
11020
11021 static void
11022 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
11023 {
11024 int tpnum = -1, num_printed;
11025
11026 if (tpnum_exp)
11027 tpnum = parse_and_eval_long (tpnum_exp);
11028
11029 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (tpnum, 0, is_tracepoint);
11030
11031 if (num_printed == 0)
11032 {
11033 if (tpnum == -1)
11034 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
11035 else
11036 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
11037 }
11038
11039 default_collect_info ();
11040 }
11041
11042 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
11043 Not supported by all targets. */
11044 static void
11045 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11046 {
11047 enable_command (args, from_tty);
11048 }
11049
11050 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
11051 Not supported by all targets. */
11052 static void
11053 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11054 {
11055 disable_command (args, from_tty);
11056 }
11057
11058 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
11059 static void
11060 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11061 {
11062 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
11063
11064 dont_repeat ();
11065
11066 if (arg == 0)
11067 {
11068 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
11069
11070 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
11071 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
11072 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
11073 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11074 {
11075 if (b->number >= 0)
11076 {
11077 breaks_to_delete = 1;
11078 break;
11079 }
11080 }
11081
11082 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
11083 if (!from_tty
11084 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
11085 {
11086 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
11087 {
11088 if (is_tracepoint (b)
11089 && b->number >= 0)
11090 delete_breakpoint (b);
11091 }
11092 }
11093 }
11094 else
11095 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
11096 }
11097
11098 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
11099
11100 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
11101 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
11102 Also accepts special argument "all". */
11103
11104 static void
11105 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11106 {
11107 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
11108 unsigned int count;
11109 int all = 0;
11110
11111 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
11112 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
11113
11114 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
11115
11116 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
11117 args++;
11118
11119 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
11120 {
11121 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
11122 all = 1;
11123 if (*args)
11124 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11125 }
11126 else
11127 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
11128
11129 do
11130 {
11131 if (t1)
11132 {
11133 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
11134 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
11135 {
11136 t2->pass_count = count;
11137 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
11138 if (from_tty)
11139 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
11140 t2->number, count);
11141 }
11142 if (! all && *args)
11143 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
11144 }
11145 }
11146 while (*args);
11147 }
11148
11149 struct breakpoint *
11150 get_tracepoint (int num)
11151 {
11152 struct breakpoint *t;
11153
11154 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11155 if (t->number == num)
11156 return t;
11157
11158 return NULL;
11159 }
11160
11161 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
11162 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
11163 reconnecting). */
11164
11165 struct breakpoint *
11166 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
11167 {
11168 struct breakpoint *t;
11169
11170 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11171 if (t->number_on_target == num)
11172 return t;
11173
11174 return NULL;
11175 }
11176
11177 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
11178 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
11179 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
11180 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
11181 struct breakpoint *
11182 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
11183 {
11184 extern int tracepoint_count;
11185 struct breakpoint *t;
11186 int tpnum;
11187 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
11188
11189 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
11190 {
11191 if (optional_p)
11192 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
11193 else
11194 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
11195 }
11196 else
11197 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
11198
11199 if (tpnum <= 0)
11200 {
11201 if (instring && *instring)
11202 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
11203 instring);
11204 else
11205 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
11206 return NULL;
11207 }
11208
11209 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11210 if (t->number == tpnum)
11211 {
11212 return t;
11213 }
11214
11215 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
11216 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
11217 allow us to discover this. */
11218 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
11219 return NULL;
11220 }
11221
11222 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
11223 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
11224 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
11225 non-zero. */
11226
11227 static void
11228 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
11229 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
11230 {
11231 struct breakpoint *tp;
11232 int any = 0;
11233 char *pathname;
11234 struct cleanup *cleanup;
11235 struct ui_file *fp;
11236 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
11237
11238 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
11239 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
11240
11241 /* See if we have anything to save. */
11242 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
11243 {
11244 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
11245 if (!user_settable_breakpoint (tp))
11246 continue;
11247
11248 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
11249 if (filter && !filter (tp))
11250 continue;
11251
11252 any = 1;
11253
11254 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
11255 {
11256 extra_trace_bits = 1;
11257
11258 /* We can stop searching. */
11259 break;
11260 }
11261 }
11262
11263 if (!any)
11264 {
11265 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
11266 return;
11267 }
11268
11269 pathname = tilde_expand (filename);
11270 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
11271 fp = gdb_fopen (pathname, "w");
11272 if (!fp)
11273 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
11274 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
11275 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
11276
11277 if (extra_trace_bits)
11278 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
11279
11280 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
11281 {
11282 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
11283 if (!user_settable_breakpoint (tp))
11284 continue;
11285
11286 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
11287 if (filter && !filter (tp))
11288 continue;
11289
11290 if (tp->ops != NULL)
11291 (tp->ops->print_recreate) (tp, fp);
11292 else
11293 {
11294 if (tp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
11295 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
11296 if (tp->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
11297 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
11298 else if (tp->type == bp_tracepoint)
11299 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
11300 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
11301 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
11302 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
11303 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
11304 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
11305 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
11306 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
11307 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
11308 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
11309 else if (tp->type == bp_watchpoint)
11310 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11311 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11312 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11313 else if (tp->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11314 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11315 else if (tp->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11316 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11317 else
11318 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11319 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
11320
11321 if (tp->exp_string)
11322 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->exp_string);
11323 else if (tp->addr_string)
11324 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->addr_string);
11325 else
11326 {
11327 char tmp[40];
11328
11329 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
11330 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " *0x%s", tmp);
11331 }
11332 }
11333
11334 if (tp->thread != -1)
11335 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", tp->thread);
11336
11337 if (tp->task != 0)
11338 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", tp->task);
11339
11340 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
11341
11342 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
11343 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
11344 instead. */
11345
11346 if (tp->cond_string)
11347 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
11348
11349 if (tp->ignore_count)
11350 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
11351
11352 if (tp->pass_count)
11353 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
11354
11355 if (tp->commands)
11356 {
11357 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
11358
11359 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
11360
11361 ui_out_redirect (uiout, fp);
11362 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
11363 {
11364 print_command_lines (uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
11365 }
11366 ui_out_redirect (uiout, NULL);
11367
11368 if (ex.reason < 0)
11369 throw_exception (ex);
11370
11371 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
11372 }
11373
11374 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
11375 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable\n");
11376
11377 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
11378 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
11379 special, and not user visible. */
11380 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
11381 {
11382 struct bp_location *loc;
11383 int n = 1;
11384
11385 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
11386 if (!loc->enabled)
11387 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
11388 }
11389 }
11390
11391 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
11392 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
11393
11394 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11395 if (from_tty)
11396 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
11397 }
11398
11399 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
11400
11401 static void
11402 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11403 {
11404 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
11405 }
11406
11407 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
11408
11409 static void
11410 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11411 {
11412 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
11413 }
11414
11415 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
11416
11417 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
11418 all_tracepoints ()
11419 {
11420 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
11421 struct breakpoint *tp;
11422
11423 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
11424 {
11425 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
11426 }
11427
11428 return tp_vec;
11429 }
11430
11431 \f
11432 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
11433 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
11434 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
11435 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
11436 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
11437 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
11438 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
11439 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
11440 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
11441 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
11442 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
11443 \n\
11444 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
11445 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
11446 \n\
11447 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
11448 conditions are different.\n\
11449 \n\
11450 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
11451
11452 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
11453 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
11454
11455 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
11456 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
11457
11458 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
11459 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
11460 static void
11461 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
11462 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
11463 struct cmd_list_element *command),
11464 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
11465 char *text, char *word),
11466 void *user_data_catch,
11467 void *user_data_tcatch)
11468 {
11469 struct cmd_list_element *command;
11470
11471 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
11472 &catch_cmdlist);
11473 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
11474 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
11475 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
11476
11477 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
11478 &tcatch_cmdlist);
11479 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
11480 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
11481 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
11482 }
11483
11484 static void
11485 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
11486 {
11487 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
11488 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
11489 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
11490 }
11491
11492 static void
11493 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11494 {
11495 printf_unfiltered (_("\
11496 \"save\" must be followed by the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
11497 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", -1, gdb_stdout);
11498 }
11499
11500 void
11501 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
11502 {
11503 struct cmd_list_element *c;
11504
11505 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
11506 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
11507 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
11508
11509 breakpoint_chain = 0;
11510 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
11511 before a breakpoint is set. */
11512 breakpoint_count = 0;
11513
11514 tracepoint_count = 0;
11515
11516 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
11517 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
11518 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
11519 if (xdb_commands)
11520 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
11521
11522 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
11523 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
11524 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
11525 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
11526 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
11527 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
11528 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
11529 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
11530
11531 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
11532 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
11533 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
11534 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
11535
11536 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
11537 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
11538 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
11539 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
11540 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
11541 \n"
11542 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
11543 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11544
11545 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
11546 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
11547 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
11548 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
11549 \n"
11550 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
11551 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11552
11553 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
11554 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
11555 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
11556 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
11557 \n"
11558 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
11559 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11560
11561 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
11562 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
11563 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
11564 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
11565 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
11566 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
11567 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
11568 if (xdb_commands)
11569 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
11570 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
11571 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
11572 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
11573 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
11574 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
11575
11576 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
11577
11578 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
11579 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
11580 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
11581 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
11582 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
11583 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
11584
11585 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
11586 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11587 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
11588 &enablebreaklist);
11589
11590 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
11591 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11592 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
11593 &enablebreaklist);
11594
11595 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
11596 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11597 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
11598 &enablelist);
11599
11600 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
11601 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11602 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
11603 &enablelist);
11604
11605 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
11606 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
11607 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11608 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11609 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
11610 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
11611 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
11612 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
11613 if (xdb_commands)
11614 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
11615 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
11616 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11617 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11618 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
11619
11620 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
11621 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
11622 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11623 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11624 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
11625 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
11626 &disablelist);
11627
11628 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
11629 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
11630 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11631 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11632 \n\
11633 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
11634 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
11635 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
11636 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
11637 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
11638 if (xdb_commands)
11639 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
11640 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
11641 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11642 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
11643
11644 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
11645 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
11646 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11647 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11648 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
11649 &deletelist);
11650
11651 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
11652 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
11653 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
11654 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
11655 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
11656 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
11657 \n\
11658 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
11659 is executing in.\n\
11660 \n\
11661 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
11662 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
11663
11664 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
11665 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
11666 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
11667 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11668
11669 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
11670 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
11671 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
11672 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
11673
11674 if (xdb_commands)
11675 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
11676
11677 if (dbx_commands)
11678 {
11679 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
11680 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
11681 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
11682 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
11683 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
11684 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
11685 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
11686 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
11687 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
11688 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
11689 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
11690 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
11691 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
11692 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
11693 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
11694 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
11695 \n\
11696 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
11697 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
11698 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
11699 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
11700 breakpoint set."));
11701 }
11702
11703 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
11704 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
11705 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
11706 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
11707 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
11708 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
11709 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
11710 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
11711 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
11712 \n\
11713 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
11714 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
11715 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
11716 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
11717 breakpoint set."));
11718
11719 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
11720
11721 if (xdb_commands)
11722 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
11723 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
11724 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
11725 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
11726 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
11727 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
11728 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
11729 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
11730 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
11731 \n\
11732 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
11733 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
11734 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
11735 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
11736 breakpoint set."));
11737
11738 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
11739 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
11740 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
11741 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
11742 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
11743 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
11744 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
11745 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
11746 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
11747 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
11748 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
11749 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
11750 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
11751 \n\
11752 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
11753 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
11754 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
11755 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
11756 breakpoint set."),
11757 &maintenanceinfolist);
11758
11759 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
11760 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
11761 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
11762 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
11763
11764 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
11765 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
11766 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
11767 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
11768
11769 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
11770 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
11771 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
11772 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
11773 catch_catch_command,
11774 NULL,
11775 CATCH_PERMANENT,
11776 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
11777 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
11778 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
11779 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
11780 catch_throw_command,
11781 NULL,
11782 CATCH_PERMANENT,
11783 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
11784 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
11785 catch_fork_command_1,
11786 NULL,
11787 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
11788 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
11789 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
11790 catch_fork_command_1,
11791 NULL,
11792 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
11793 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
11794 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
11795 catch_exec_command_1,
11796 NULL,
11797 CATCH_PERMANENT,
11798 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
11799 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
11800 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
11801 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
11802 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
11803 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
11804 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
11805 catch_syscall_command_1,
11806 catch_syscall_completer,
11807 CATCH_PERMANENT,
11808 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
11809 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
11810 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
11811 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
11812 catch_ada_exception_command,
11813 NULL,
11814 CATCH_PERMANENT,
11815 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
11816 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
11817 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
11818 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
11819 catch_assert_command,
11820 NULL,
11821 CATCH_PERMANENT,
11822 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
11823
11824 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
11825 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
11826 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
11827 an expression changes."));
11828 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
11829
11830 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
11831 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
11832 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
11833 an expression is read."));
11834 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
11835
11836 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
11837 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
11838 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
11839 an expression is either read or written."));
11840 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
11841
11842 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
11843 Status of watchpoints, or watchpoint number NUMBER."));
11844
11845
11846
11847 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
11848 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
11849 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
11850 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
11851 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
11852 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
11853 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
11854 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
11855 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
11856 hardware.)"),
11857 NULL,
11858 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
11859 &setlist, &showlist);
11860
11861 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
11862
11863 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
11864
11865 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
11866 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
11867 \n"
11868 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
11869 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
11870 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11871
11872 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
11873 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
11874 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
11875 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
11876
11877 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
11878 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
11879 \n"
11880 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
11881 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
11882 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11883
11884 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
11885 Set a static tracepoint at specified line, function or marker.\n\
11886 \n\
11887 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
11888 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, \"*\" and an address,\n\
11889 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\
11890 If a line number is specified, probe the marker at start of code\n\
11891 for that line. If a function is specified, probe the marker at start\n\
11892 of code for that function. If an address is specified, probe the marker\n\
11893 at that exact address. If a marker id is specified, probe the marker\n\
11894 with that name. With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of\n\
11895 the selected stack frame.\n\
11896 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
11897 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
11898 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
11899 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
11900 \n\
11901 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
11902 \n\
11903 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
11904 conditions are different.\n\
11905 \n\
11906 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
11907 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
11908 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11909
11910 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
11911 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
11912 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
11913 last tracepoint set."));
11914
11915 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
11916
11917 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
11918 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
11919 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
11920 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
11921 &deletelist);
11922
11923 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
11924 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
11925 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
11926 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
11927 &disablelist);
11928 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
11929
11930 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
11931 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
11932 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
11933 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
11934 &enablelist);
11935 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
11936
11937 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
11938 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
11939 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
11940 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
11941 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
11942
11943 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
11944 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
11945 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
11946 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
11947
11948 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
11949 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
11950 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
11951 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
11952 session to restore them."),
11953 &save_cmdlist);
11954 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
11955
11956 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
11957 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
11958 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
11959 &save_cmdlist);
11960 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
11961
11962 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
11963 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
11964
11965 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
11966 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
11967 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
11968 pending breakpoint behavior"),
11969 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
11970 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
11971 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
11972 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
11973 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
11974 pending breakpoint behavior"),
11975 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
11976 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
11977
11978 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
11979 &pending_break_support, _("\
11980 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
11981 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
11982 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
11983 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
11984 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
11985 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
11986 NULL,
11987 show_pending_break_support,
11988 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
11989 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
11990
11991 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
11992
11993 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
11994 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
11995 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
11996 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
11997 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
11998 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
11999 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
12000 NULL,
12001 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
12002 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12003 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12004
12005 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
12006 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
12007 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
12008 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
12009 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
12010 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
12011 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
12012 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
12013 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
12014 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
12015 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
12016 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
12017 NULL,
12018 &show_always_inserted_mode,
12019 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12020 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12021
12022 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
12023
12024 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
12025 }
This page took 0.316528 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.